Linux Audio

Check our new training course

Loading...
v3.1
   1/*
   2 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   3 *
   4 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   5 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   6 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
 
 
 
   7 *
   8 * This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
   9 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License version 2 as
  10 * published by the Free Software Foundation.
  11 */
  12
  13#ifndef MAC80211_H
  14#define MAC80211_H
  15
 
  16#include <linux/kernel.h>
  17#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  18#include <linux/skbuff.h>
  19#include <linux/wireless.h>
  20#include <linux/device.h>
  21#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  22#include <net/cfg80211.h>
 
  23#include <asm/unaligned.h>
  24
  25/**
  26 * DOC: Introduction
  27 *
  28 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  29 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  30 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  31 * drivers.
  32 */
  33
  34/**
  35 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  36 *
  37 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  38 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  39 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  40 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  41 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  42 * tasklet function.
  43 *
  44 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  45 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  46 */
  47
  48/**
  49 * DOC: Warning
  50 *
  51 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  52 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  53 */
  54
  55/**
  56 * DOC: Frame format
  57 *
  58 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  59 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  60 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  61 * hardware.
  62 *
  63 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  64 *
  65 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  66 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  67 *
  68 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  69 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
  70 *
  71 * Finally, for received frames, the driver is able to indicate that it has
  72 * filled a radiotap header and put that in front of the frame; if it does
  73 * not do so then mac80211 may add this under certain circumstances.
  74 */
  75
  76/**
  77 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  78 *
  79 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  80 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  81 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  82 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  83 *
  84 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  85 * suspend.
  86 *
  87 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  88 *
  89 */
  90
  91/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  92 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
  93 *
  94 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 
  95 */
  96enum ieee80211_max_queues {
  97	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		4,
 
  98};
  99
 
 
 100/**
 101 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 102 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 103 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 104 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 105 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 106 */
 107enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 108	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 109	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 110	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 111	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 112};
 113
 114/**
 115 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 116 *
 117 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 118 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 119 *
 120 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 121 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 122 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 123 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 124 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 
 125 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 126 */
 127struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 128	u16 txop;
 129	u16 cw_min;
 130	u16 cw_max;
 131	u8 aifs;
 
 132	bool uapsd;
 133};
 134
 135struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 136	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 137	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 138	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 139	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 140};
 141
 142/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 143 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 144 *
 145 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed() callback
 146 * to indicate which BSS parameter changed.
 147 *
 148 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 149 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 150 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 151 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 152 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 153 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 154 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 155 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 156 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 157 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 158 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 159 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 160 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 161 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 162 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 163 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 164 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 165 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 166 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 167 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 168 */
 169enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 170	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 171	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 172	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 173	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 174	BSS_CHANGED_HT                  = 1<<4,
 175	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 176	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 177	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 178	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 179	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 180	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 181	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 182	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 183	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 184	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 185
 186	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 187};
 188
 189/*
 190 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 191 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 192 * filtering will be disabled.
 193 */
 194#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 195
 196/**
 197 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event - RSSI threshold event
 198 * An indicator for when RSSI goes below/above a certain threshold.
 199 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi crossed the high threshold set by the driver.
 200 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi crossed the low threshold set by the driver.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 201 */
 202enum ieee80211_rssi_event {
 203	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 204	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 205};
 206
 207/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 208 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 209 *
 210 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 211 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 212 *
 213 * @assoc: association status
 214 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS
 215 *	or not
 
 216 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
 217 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 218 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble;
 219 *	if the hardware cannot handle this it must set the
 220 *	IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_PREAMBLE_INCAPABLE hardware flag
 221 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP);
 222 *	if the hardware cannot handle this it must set the
 223 *	IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_SLOT_INCAPABLE hardware flag
 224 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 225 *	valid in station mode only while @assoc is true and if also
 226 *	requested by %IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_PERIOD (cf. also hw conf
 227 *	@ps_dtim_period)
 228 * @timestamp: beacon timestamp
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 229 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 230 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 231 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 232 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 233 *	the current band.
 
 234 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 235 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 236 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 237 * @channel_type: Channel type for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 238 *	configured for HT40+ while this BSS only uses no-HT, for
 239 *	example.
 240 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode (like in &struct ieee80211_ht_info).
 241 *	This field is only valid when the channel type is one of the HT types.
 
 
 242 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 243 *	implies disabled
 
 
 
 
 
 
 244 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 245 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
 246 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
 247 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
 248 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
 249 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list.
 250 * @arp_filter_enabled: Enable ARP filtering - if enabled, the hardware may
 251 *	filter ARP queries based on the @arp_addr_list, if disabled, the
 252 *	hardware must not perform any ARP filtering. Note, that the filter will
 253 *	be enabled also in promiscuous mode.
 254 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 255 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
 256 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
 257 *	your driver/device needs to do.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 258 */
 259struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 260	const u8 *bssid;
 261	/* association related data */
 262	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
 
 263	u16 aid;
 264	/* erp related data */
 265	bool use_cts_prot;
 266	bool use_short_preamble;
 267	bool use_short_slot;
 268	bool enable_beacon;
 269	u8 dtim_period;
 270	u16 beacon_int;
 271	u16 assoc_capability;
 272	u64 timestamp;
 
 
 273	u32 basic_rates;
 274	int mcast_rate[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS];
 
 275	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 276	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 277	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 278	enum nl80211_channel_type channel_type;
 
 
 
 279	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
 280	u8 arp_addr_cnt;
 281	bool arp_filter_enabled;
 282	bool qos;
 283	bool idle;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 284};
 285
 286/**
 287 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 288 *
 289 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 290 *
 291 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 292 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 293 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 294 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 295 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 296 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 297 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 298 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 299 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 300 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 301 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 302 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 303 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 304 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 305 *	station
 306 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 307 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 308 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 309 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 310 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 311 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 312 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 313 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 314 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 315 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 316 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 317 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 318 *	hardware queue.
 319 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 320 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 321 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 322 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 323 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 324 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 325 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 326 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 
 
 
 327 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 328 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 329 *	it can be sent out.
 330 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 331 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 332 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 333 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 334 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PSPOLL_RESPONSE: (internal?)
 335 *	This frame is a response to a PS-poll frame and should be sent
 336 *	although the station is in powersave mode.
 337 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 338 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 339 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 340 *	queue gets full.
 341 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 342 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 343 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 344 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_HAS_RADIOTAP: This frame was injected and still
 345 *	has a radiotap header at skb->data.
 
 346 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 347 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 348 *	status to user space)
 349 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 350 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 351 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 352 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 353 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 354 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 355 *	handled properly by the device.
 356 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 357 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 358 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 359 *
 360 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 361 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 362 */
 363enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
 364	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 365	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 366	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 367	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 368	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 369	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 370	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 371	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 372	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 373	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 374	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 375	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 376	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 
 377	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(14),
 378	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 379	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 380	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PSPOLL_RESPONSE	= BIT(17),
 381	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 382	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 383	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_HAS_RADIOTAP		= BIT(20),
 384	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 385	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 386	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 387	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 388	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 
 
 
 
 
 389};
 390
 391#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 392
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 393/*
 394 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
 395 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
 396 */
 397#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
 398	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
 399	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
 400	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
 401	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
 402	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_PSPOLL_RESPONSE | \
 403	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
 404	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC)
 405
 406/**
 407 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
 408 *	Rate Control algorithm.
 409 *
 410 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
 411 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
 412 *
 413 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
 414 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
 415 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
 416 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
 417 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
 
 
 418 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
 419 *	Greenfield mode.
 420 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
 
 
 
 421 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
 422 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
 423 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
 424 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
 425 */
 426enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
 427	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
 428	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
 429	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
 430
 431	/* rate index is an MCS rate number instead of an index */
 432	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
 433	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
 434	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
 435	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
 436	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
 
 
 
 437};
 438
 439
 440/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
 441#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
 442
 443/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
 444#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
 445
 446/* maximum number of rate stages */
 447#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	5
 
 
 
 448
 449/**
 450 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
 451 *
 452 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
 453 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
 454 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
 455 *
 456 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
 457 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
 458 *
 459 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
 460 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
 461 *
 462 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
 463 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
 464 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
 465 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
 466 * information
 
 467 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
 
 468 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
 469 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
 470 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
 471 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
 472 * information should then contain
 
 473 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
 
 474 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
 475 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
 476 */
 477struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
 478	s8 idx;
 479	u8 count;
 480	u8 flags;
 481} __packed;
 482
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 483/**
 484 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
 485 *
 486 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
 487 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
 488 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
 489 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
 490 *
 491 * The TX control's sta pointer is only valid during the ->tx call,
 492 * it may be NULL.
 493 *
 494 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
 495 * @band: the band to transmit on (use for checking for races)
 496 * @antenna_sel_tx: antenna to use, 0 for automatic diversity
 497 * @pad: padding, ignore
 498 * @control: union for control data
 499 * @status: union for status data
 500 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
 501 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
 502 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
 503 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
 504 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
 505 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
 506 */
 507struct ieee80211_tx_info {
 508	/* common information */
 509	u32 flags;
 510	u8 band;
 511
 512	u8 antenna_sel_tx;
 513
 514	/* 2 byte hole */
 515	u8 pad[2];
 516
 517	union {
 518		struct {
 519			union {
 520				/* rate control */
 521				struct {
 522					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
 523						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 524					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
 
 
 
 
 
 525				};
 526				/* only needed before rate control */
 527				unsigned long jiffies;
 528			};
 529			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
 530			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 531			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
 532			struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 
 533		} control;
 534		struct {
 
 
 
 535			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 
 536			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
 537			int ack_signal;
 538			u8 ampdu_len;
 539			/* 15 bytes free */
 
 
 
 540		} status;
 541		struct {
 542			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
 543				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 
 
 544			void *rate_driver_data[
 545				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
 546		};
 547		void *driver_data[
 548			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
 549	};
 550};
 551
 552/**
 553 * struct ieee80211_sched_scan_ies - scheduled scan IEs
 554 *
 555 * This structure is used to pass the appropriate IEs to be used in scheduled
 556 * scans for all bands.  It contains both the IEs passed from the userspace
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 557 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
 558 *
 559 * @ie: array with the IEs for each supported band
 560 * @len: array with the total length of the IEs for each band
 561 */
 562struct ieee80211_sched_scan_ies {
 563	u8 *ie[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS];
 564	size_t len[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS];
 
 
 
 
 565};
 566
 
 567static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
 568{
 569	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
 570}
 571
 572static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
 573{
 574	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
 575}
 576
 577/**
 578 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
 579 *
 580 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
 581 *
 582 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
 583 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
 584 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
 585 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
 586 *
 587 * NOTE: You can only use this function if you do NOT use
 588 *	 info->driver_data! Use info->rate_driver_data
 589 *	 instead if you need only the less space that allows.
 590 */
 591static inline void
 592ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
 593{
 594	int i;
 595
 596	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
 597		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
 598	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
 599		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
 600	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
 601	/* clear the rate counts */
 602	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
 603		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
 604
 605	BUILD_BUG_ON(
 606	    offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len) != 23);
 607	memset(&info->status.ampdu_ack_len, 0,
 608	       sizeof(struct ieee80211_tx_info) -
 609	       offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len));
 610}
 611
 612
 613/**
 614 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
 615 *
 616 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
 617 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
 618 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
 619 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
 620 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
 621 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
 622 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV/ICV are stripped from this frame.
 623 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
 624 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 625 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
 626 *	the frame.
 627 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
 628 *	the frame.
 629 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_MPDU: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
 630 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
 631 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
 632 *	merging.
 633 * @RX_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
 634 * @RX_FLAG_HT: HT MCS was used and rate_idx is MCS index
 635 * @RX_FLAG_40MHZ: HT40 (40 MHz) was used
 636 * @RX_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 637 */
 638enum mac80211_rx_flags {
 639	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR	= 1<<0,
 640	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED	= 1<<1,
 641	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED	= 1<<3,
 642	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED	= 1<<4,
 643	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC	= 1<<5,
 644	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = 1<<6,
 645	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_MPDU	= 1<<7,
 646	RX_FLAG_SHORTPRE	= 1<<8,
 647	RX_FLAG_HT		= 1<<9,
 648	RX_FLAG_40MHZ		= 1<<10,
 649	RX_FLAG_SHORT_GI	= 1<<11,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 650};
 651
 652/**
 653 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
 654 *
 655 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
 656 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
 657 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
 658 *
 659 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
 660 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
 
 
 
 
 661 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
 662 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
 
 
 663 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
 664 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
 665 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
 
 
 
 
 666 * @antenna: antenna used
 667 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
 668 *	HT rates are use (RX_FLAG_HT)
 669 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_*
 
 
 
 
 670 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
 
 
 
 671 */
 672struct ieee80211_rx_status {
 673	u64 mactime;
 674	enum ieee80211_band band;
 675	int freq;
 676	int signal;
 677	int antenna;
 678	int rate_idx;
 679	int flag;
 680	unsigned int rx_flags;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 681};
 682
 683/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 684 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
 685 *
 686 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
 687 *
 688 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
 689 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
 690 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
 691 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
 692 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
 693 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
 694 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
 695 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
 696 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
 697 *	for more.
 698 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
 699 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
 700 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
 701 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
 702 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
 703 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
 704 *	operating channel.
 705 */
 706enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
 707	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
 708	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
 709	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
 710	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
 711};
 712
 713
 714/**
 715 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
 716 *
 717 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
 718 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
 719 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
 720 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
 721 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
 722 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
 723 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
 724 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
 
 
 725 */
 726enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
 727	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
 728	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
 729	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
 730	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
 731	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
 732	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
 733	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
 734	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
 735};
 736
 737/**
 738 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
 739 *
 740 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
 741 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
 742 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
 743 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
 744 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
 745 */
 746enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
 747	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
 748	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
 749	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
 750	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
 751
 752	/* keep last */
 753	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
 754};
 755
 756/**
 757 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
 758 *
 759 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
 760 *
 761 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
 762 *
 763 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
 764 * @max_sleep_period: the maximum number of beacon intervals to sleep for
 765 *	before checking the beacon for a TIM bit (managed mode only); this
 766 *	value will be only achievable between DTIM frames, the hardware
 767 *	needs to check for the multicast traffic bit in DTIM beacons.
 768 *	This variable is valid only when the CONF_PS flag is set.
 769 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
 770 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
 771 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
 772 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
 773 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
 774 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
 775 *
 776 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm)
 
 777 *
 778 * @channel: the channel to tune to
 779 * @channel_type: the channel (HT) type
 780 *
 781 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
 782 *    (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
 783 *    but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
 784 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
 785 *    frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
 786 *    number of transmissions not the number of retries
 787 *
 788 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
 789 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
 790 *	configured for an HT channel
 
 
 791 */
 792struct ieee80211_conf {
 793	u32 flags;
 794	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
 795	int max_sleep_period;
 796
 797	u16 listen_interval;
 798	u8 ps_dtim_period;
 799
 800	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
 801
 802	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
 803	enum nl80211_channel_type channel_type;
 804	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
 805};
 806
 807/**
 808 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
 809 *
 810 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
 811 * operation.
 812 *
 813 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
 814 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
 815 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
 816 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
 
 
 817 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
 818 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
 819 * @channel: the new channel to switch to
 820 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
 821 */
 822struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
 823	u64 timestamp;
 
 824	bool block_tx;
 825	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
 826	u8 count;
 827};
 828
 829/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 830 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
 831 *
 832 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
 833 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
 834 *
 835 * @type: type of this virtual interface
 836 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
 837 *	or the BSS we're associated to
 838 * @addr: address of this interface
 839 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
 840 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 841 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 842 *	sizeof(void *).
 
 843 */
 844struct ieee80211_vif {
 845	enum nl80211_iftype type;
 846	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
 847	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
 848	bool p2p;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 849	/* must be last */
 850	u8 drv_priv[0] __attribute__((__aligned__(sizeof(void *))));
 851};
 852
 853static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
 854{
 855#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
 856	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
 857#endif
 858	return false;
 859}
 860
 861/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 862 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
 863 *
 864 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
 865 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
 866 *
 867 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_WMM_STA: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
 868 *	that the STA this key will be used with could be using QoS.
 869 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
 870 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
 871 *	particular key.
 
 872 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
 873 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
 874 *	generation in software.
 875 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
 876 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
 877 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT: This flag should be set by the driver for a
 878 *	CCMP key if it requires CCMP encryption of management frames (MFP) to
 879 *	be done in software.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 880 */
 881enum ieee80211_key_flags {
 882	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_WMM_STA	= 1<<0,
 883	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV	= 1<<1,
 884	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC= 1<<2,
 885	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE	= 1<<3,
 886	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT	= 1<<4,
 
 
 
 
 887};
 888
 889/**
 890 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
 891 *
 892 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
 893 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
 894 *
 895 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
 896 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
 897 *	encrypted in hardware.
 898 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
 
 
 899 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
 900 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
 901 * @keylen: key material length
 902 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
 903 * 	data block:
 904 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
 905 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
 906 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
 907 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
 908 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
 909 */
 910struct ieee80211_key_conf {
 
 911	u32 cipher;
 912	u8 icv_len;
 913	u8 iv_len;
 914	u8 hw_key_idx;
 915	u8 flags;
 916	s8 keyidx;
 
 917	u8 keylen;
 918	u8 key[0];
 919};
 920
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 921/**
 922 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
 923 *
 924 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
 925 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
 926 *
 927 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
 928 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
 929 */
 930enum set_key_cmd {
 931	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
 932};
 933
 934/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 935 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
 936 *
 937 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
 938 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
 939 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
 940 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
 941 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
 942 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
 943 *
 944 * @addr: MAC address
 945 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
 946 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates (per band)
 947 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own TX capabilities
 948 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports WME. Only valid during AP-mode.
 
 
 
 
 
 949 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 950 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 951 */
 952struct ieee80211_sta {
 953	u32 supp_rates[IEEE80211_NUM_BANDS];
 954	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
 955	u16 aid;
 956	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
 
 
 957	bool wme;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 958
 959	/* must be last */
 960	u8 drv_priv[0] __attribute__((__aligned__(sizeof(void *))));
 961};
 962
 963/**
 964 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
 965 *
 966 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
 967 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
 968 *
 969 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
 970 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
 971 */
 972enum sta_notify_cmd {
 973	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
 974};
 975
 976/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 977 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
 978 *
 979 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
 980 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
 981 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
 982 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
 983 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
 984 *
 985 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
 986 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
 987 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
 988 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
 989 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
 990 *	algorithm.
 991 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
 992 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
 993 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
 994 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
 995 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
 996 *	CCK frames.
 997 *
 998 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
 999 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
1000 *	the FCS at the end.
1001 *
1002 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
1003 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
1004 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
1005 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
1006 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
1007 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
1008 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
1009 *
1010 * @IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_SLOT_INCAPABLE:
1011 *	Hardware is not capable of short slot operation on the 2.4 GHz band.
1012 *
1013 * @IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_PREAMBLE_INCAPABLE:
1014 *	Hardware is not capable of receiving frames with short preamble on
1015 *	the 2.4 GHz band.
1016 *
1017 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
1018 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
1019 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
1020 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
1021 *
1022 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
1023 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
1024 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
1025 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
1026 *
1027 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
1028 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
1029 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
1030 *
1031 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
1032 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
1033 *
1034 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
1035 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
1036 *
1037 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
1038 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
1039 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
1040 *
1041 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
1042 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
1043 *
1044 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
1045 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
1046 *
1047 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER:
1048 *	Hardware supports dropping of irrelevant beacon frames to
1049 *	avoid waking up cpu.
1050 *
1051 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_STATIC_SMPS:
1052 *	Hardware supports static spatial multiplexing powersave,
1053 *	ie. can turn off all but one chain even on HT connections
1054 *	that should be using more chains.
1055 *
1056 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_SMPS:
1057 *	Hardware supports dynamic spatial multiplexing powersave,
1058 *	ie. can turn off all but one chain and then wake the rest
1059 *	up as required after, for example, rts/cts handshake.
1060 *
1061 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_UAPSD:
1062 *	Hardware supports Unscheduled Automatic Power Save Delivery
1063 *	(U-APSD) in managed mode. The mode is configured with
1064 *	conf_tx() operation.
1065 *
1066 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
1067 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
1068 *	the stack.
1069 *
1070 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
1071 *      The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
1072 *      periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
1073 *      When this flag is set, signaling beacon-loss will cause an immediate
1074 *      change to disassociated state.
1075 *
1076 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI:
1077 *	Hardware can do connection quality monitoring - i.e. it can monitor
1078 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1079 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1080 *
1081 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_PERIOD:
1082 *	This device needs to know the DTIM period for the BSS before
1083 *	associating.
1084 *
1085 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
1086 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
1087 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
1088 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
1089 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
1090 *	only in that case.
1091 *
1092 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
1093 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
1094 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
1095 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
1096 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
1097 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1098 */
1099enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
1100	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL			= 1<<0,
1101	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS			= 1<<1,
1102	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING	= 1<<2,
1103	IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_SLOT_INCAPABLE		= 1<<3,
1104	IEEE80211_HW_2GHZ_SHORT_PREAMBLE_INCAPABLE	= 1<<4,
1105	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC			= 1<<5,
1106	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM				= 1<<6,
1107	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_PERIOD			= 1<<7,
1108	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT			= 1<<8,
1109	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION			= 1<<9,
1110	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS			= 1<<10,
1111	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK			= 1<<11,
1112	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS		= 1<<12,
1113	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE			= 1<<13,
1114	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER			= 1<<14,
1115	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_STATIC_SMPS		= 1<<15,
1116	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_SMPS		= 1<<16,
1117	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_UAPSD			= 1<<17,
1118	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS		= 1<<18,
1119	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR			= 1<<19,
1120	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI			= 1<<20,
1121	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK		= 1<<21,
1122	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS				= 1<<22,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1123};
1124
1125/**
1126 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
1127 *
1128 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
1129 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
1130 *
1131 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
1132 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
1133 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
1134 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
1135 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
1136 *
1137 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
1138 *
1139 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
1140 *	along with this structure.
1141 *
1142 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
1143 *
1144 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
1145 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
1146 *
1147 * @channel_change_time: time (in microseconds) it takes to change channels.
 
1148 *
1149 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
1150 *     only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
1151 *
1152 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
1153 *     that HW supports
1154 *
1155 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
1156 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
1157 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
1158 *
1159 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
1160 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
1161 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
1162 *
1163 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
1164 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
1165 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
1166 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
 
 
 
 
1167 *
1168 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
1169 *	can handle.
1170 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
1171 *	the hw can report back.
1172 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
1173 *
1174 * @napi_weight: weight used for NAPI polling.  You must specify an
1175 *	appropriate value here if a napi_poll operation is provided
1176 *	by your driver.
1177 *
1178 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
1179 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
1180 *	aggregation.
1181 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
1182 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
1183 *	it shouldn't be set.
1184 *
1185 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
1186 *	aggregate an HT driver will transmit, used by the peer as a
1187 *	hint to size its reorder buffer.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1188 */
1189struct ieee80211_hw {
1190	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
1191	struct wiphy *wiphy;
1192	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
1193	void *priv;
1194	u32 flags;
1195	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
1196	int channel_change_time;
1197	int vif_data_size;
1198	int sta_data_size;
1199	int napi_weight;
 
1200	u16 queues;
1201	u16 max_listen_interval;
1202	s8 max_signal;
1203	u8 max_rates;
1204	u8 max_report_rates;
1205	u8 max_rate_tries;
1206	u8 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
1207	u8 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1208};
1209
1210/**
1211 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
1212 *
1213 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
1214 *
1215 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
1216 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
1217 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
1218 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
1219 * is already used internally by mac80211.
 
 
1220 */
1221struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
1222
1223/**
1224 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
1225 *
1226 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
1227 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
1228 */
1229static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
1230{
1231	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
1232}
1233
1234/**
1235 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
1236 *
1237 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
1238 * @addr: the address to set
1239 */
1240static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 *addr)
1241{
1242	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
1243}
1244
1245static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
1246ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1247		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
1248{
1249	if (WARN_ON(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
1250		return NULL;
1251	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
1252}
1253
1254static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
1255ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1256			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
1257{
1258	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
1259		return NULL;
1260	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
1261}
1262
1263static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
1264ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1265			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
1266{
1267	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
1268		return NULL;
1269	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
1270}
1271
1272/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1273 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
1274 *
1275 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
1276 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
1277 *
1278 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
1279 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
1280 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
1281 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
1282 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
1283 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
1284 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
1285 *
1286 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
1287 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
1288 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
1289 *
1290 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
1291 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
1292 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
1293 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
1294 *
 
 
 
 
 
1295 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
1296 *
1297 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
1298 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
1299 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
1300 * based on the receive flags.
1301 *
1302 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
1303 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
1304 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
1305 * keys.
1306 *
1307 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
1308 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
1309 * handler.
1310 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
1311 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
1312 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
1313 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
1314 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
1315 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
 
 
 
 
1316 */
1317
1318/**
1319 * DOC: Powersave support
1320 *
1321 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
1322 *
1323 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
1324 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
1325 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
1326 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
1327 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
1328 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
1329 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
1330 * it finds traffic directed to it.
1331 *
1332 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
1333 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
1334 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
1335 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
1336 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
1337 *
1338 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
1339 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
1340 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
1341 *
1342 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
1343 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
1344 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
1345 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
1346 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
1347 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
1348 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
1349 *
1350 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
1351 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
1352 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
1353 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
1354 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
1355 * periods.
1356 *
1357 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
1358 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
1359 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
1360 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
1361 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
1362 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
1363 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
1364 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
1365 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
1366 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
1367 *
1368 * Some hardware need to toggle a single shared antenna between WLAN and
1369 * Bluetooth to facilitate co-existence. These types of hardware set
1370 * limitations on the use of host controlled dynamic powersave whenever there
1371 * is simultaneous WLAN and Bluetooth traffic. For these types of hardware, the
1372 * driver may request temporarily going into full power save, in order to
1373 * enable toggling the antenna between BT and WLAN. If the driver requests
1374 * disabling dynamic powersave, the @dynamic_ps_timeout value will be
1375 * temporarily set to zero until the driver re-enables dynamic powersave.
1376 *
1377 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
1378 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
1379 * uapsd paramater in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
1380 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
1381 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
1382 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
1383 *
1384 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
1385 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
1386 */
1387
1388/**
1389 * DOC: Beacon filter support
1390 *
1391 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
1392 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usuallly works so that
1393 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
1394 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
1395 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
1396 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
1397 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
1398 *
1399 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER
1400 * hardware capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
1401 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
1402 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
1403 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
1404 *
1405 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
1406 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
1407 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
1408 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
1409 *
1410 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
1411 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
1412 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
1413 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
 
1414 *  - a list of information element IDs
1415 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
1416 *
1417 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
1418 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
1419 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
1420 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
1421 * vendor information elements.
1422 *
1423 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
1424 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
1425 *
1426 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
1427 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
1428 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
1429 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
1430 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
1431 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
1432 *
1433 *
1434 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
1435 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
1436 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
1437 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
1438 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
1439 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
1440 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
1441 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
1442 *
1443 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
1444 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
1445 * signal strength threshold checking.
1446 */
1447
1448/**
1449 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
1450 *
1451 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
1452 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
1453 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
1454 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
1455 *
1456 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
1457 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
1458 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
1459 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
1460 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
1461 * hardware flags.
1462 *
1463 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
1464 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
1465 * turned off otherwise.
1466 *
1467 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
1468 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
1469 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
1470 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
1471 */
1472
1473/**
1474 * DOC: Frame filtering
1475 *
1476 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
1477 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
1478 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
1479 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
1480 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
1481 *
1482 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
1483 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
1484 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
1485 *
1486 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
1487 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
1488 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
1489 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
1490 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
1491 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
1492 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
1493 *
1494 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
1495 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
1496 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
1497 * or dropped.
1498 *
1499 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
1500 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
1501 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
1502 * the flag, but not clear it.
1503 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
1504 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
1505 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
1506 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
1507 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
1508 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
1509 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
1510 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
1511 */
1512
1513/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1514 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
1515 *
1516 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
1517 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
1518 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
1519 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
1520 *
1521 * @FIF_PROMISC_IN_BSS: promiscuous mode within your BSS,
1522 *	think of the BSS as your network segment and then this corresponds
1523 *	to the regular ethernet device promiscuous mode.
1524 *
1525 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
1526 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
1527 *	multicast address.
1528 *
1529 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
1530 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
1531 *
1532 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
1533 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
1534 *
1535 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
1536 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
1537 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
1538 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
1539 *	honour this flag if possible.
1540 *
1541 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll), if PROMISC_IN_BSS
1542 * 	is not set then only those addressed to this station.
1543 *
1544 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
1545 *
1546 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames, if PROMISC_IN_BSS is not set then only
1547 * 	those addressed to this station.
1548 *
1549 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
1550 */
1551enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
1552	FIF_PROMISC_IN_BSS	= 1<<0,
1553	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
1554	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
1555	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
1556	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
1557	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
1558	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
1559	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
1560	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
1561};
1562
1563/**
1564 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
1565 *
1566 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
1567 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
1568 *
1569 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
1570 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
1571 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
1572 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
1573 *
1574 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start Rx aggregation
1575 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop Rx aggregation
1576 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start Tx aggregation
1577 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP: stop Tx aggregation
1578 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1579 */
1580enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
1581	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
1582	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
1583	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
1584	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP,
 
 
1585	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
1586};
1587
1588/**
1589 * enum ieee80211_tx_sync_type - TX sync type
1590 * @IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_AUTH: sync TX for authentication
1591 *	(and possibly also before direct probe)
1592 * @IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_ASSOC: sync TX for association
1593 * @IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_ACTION: sync TX for action frame
1594 *	(not implemented yet)
1595 */
1596enum ieee80211_tx_sync_type {
1597	IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_AUTH,
1598	IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_ASSOC,
1599	IEEE80211_TX_SYNC_ACTION,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1600};
1601
1602/**
1603 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
1604 *
1605 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
1606 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
1607 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
1608 *
1609 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
1610 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
1611 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
1612 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
1613 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately, more
1614 *	importantly, however, it must never fail for A-MPDU-queues.
1615 *	This function should return NETDEV_TX_OK except in very
1616 *	limited cases.
1617 *	Must be implemented and atomic.
1618 *
1619 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
1620 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
1621 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
1622 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
1623 *	or zero.
1624 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
1625 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
1626 *	is added.
1627 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
1628 *
1629 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
1630 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
1631 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
1632 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
1633 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
1634 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
1635 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
1636 *
1637 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
1638 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
1639 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
1640 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
1641 *	reconfigured at resume time.
1642 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
1643 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
1644 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
1645 *	must return 1 from this function.
1646 *
1647 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
1648 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
1649 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
1650 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
1651 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
1652 *
 
 
 
 
 
1653 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
1654 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
1655 *	and @stop must be implemented.
1656 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
1657 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
1658 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
1659 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
1660 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
1661 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
1662 *
1663 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
1664 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
1665 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
1666 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
1667 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
1668 *
1669 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
1670 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
1671 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
1672 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
1673 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
1674 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
1675 *	MAC address of the device going away.
1676 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
1677 *
1678 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
1679 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
1680 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
1681 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
1682 *
1683 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
1684 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
1685 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
1686 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
1687 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
1688 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
1689 *	can sleep.
1690 *
1691 * @tx_sync: Called before a frame is sent to an AP/GO. In the GO case, the
1692 *	driver should sync with the GO's powersaving so the device doesn't
1693 *	transmit the frame while the GO is asleep. In the regular AP case
1694 *	it may be used by drivers for devices implementing other restrictions
1695 *	on talking to APs, e.g. due to regulatory enforcement or just HW
1696 *	restrictions.
1697 *	This function is called for every authentication, association and
1698 *	action frame separately since applications might attempt to auth
1699 *	with multiple APs before chosing one to associate to. If it returns
1700 *	an error, the corresponding authentication, association or frame
1701 *	transmission is aborted and reported as having failed. It is always
1702 *	called after tuning to the correct channel.
1703 *	The callback might be called multiple times before @finish_tx_sync
1704 *	(but @finish_tx_sync will be called once for each) but in practice
1705 *	this is unlikely to happen. It can also refuse in that case if the
1706 *	driver cannot handle that situation.
1707 *	This callback can sleep.
1708 * @finish_tx_sync: Called as a counterpart to @tx_sync, unless that returned
1709 *	an error. This callback can sleep.
1710 *
1711 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
1712 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
1713 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
1714 *
1715 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
1716 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
1717 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
1718 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1719 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
1720 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
1721 *
1722 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
1723 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
1724 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
1725 *	is enabled.
1726 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
1727 *	The callback can sleep.
1728 *
1729 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
1730 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
1731 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
1732 *	The callback must be atomic.
1733 *
1734 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
1735 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
1736 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
1737 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
1738 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
1739 *
 
 
 
 
1740 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
1741 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
1742 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
1743 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
1744 *	that power save is disabled.
1745 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
1746 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
1747 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
1748 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
1749 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
1750 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
1751 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
1752 *	The callback can sleep.
1753 *
1754 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
1755 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
1756 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
1757 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
1758 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
1759 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
1760 *	The callback can sleep.
1761 *
1762 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
1763 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
1764 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
1765 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
1766 *
1767 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
 
1768 *
1769 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
1770 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
1771 *	The callback can sleep.
 
 
1772 *
1773 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
1774 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
1775 *	this notification.
1776 *	The callback can sleep.
1777 *
1778 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
1779 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
1780 *	The callback can sleep.
1781 *
1782 * @get_tkip_seq: If your device implements TKIP encryption in hardware this
1783 *	callback should be provided to read the TKIP transmit IVs (both IV32
1784 *	and IV16) for the given key from hardware.
1785 *	The callback must be atomic.
1786 *
1787 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
1788 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself; if this callback is
1789 *	implemented then the stack will not do fragmentation.
 
1790 *	The callback can sleep.
1791 *
1792 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
1793 *	The callback can sleep.
1794 *
1795 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
1796 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
1797 *
1798 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
1799 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1800 *
1801 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
1802 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
1803 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
1804 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
1805 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1806 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
1807 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
1808 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
1809 *	The callback can sleep.
1810 *
1811 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
1812 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
1813 *	required function.
1814 *	The callback can sleep.
1815 *
1816 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
1817 *      Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
1818 *	required function.
1819 *	The callback can sleep.
1820 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
1821 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
1822 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
1823 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
1824 *	TSF synchronization.
1825 *	The callback can sleep.
1826 *
1827 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
1828 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
1829 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
1830 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
1831 *	The callback can sleep.
1832 *
1833 * @ampdu_action: Perform a certain A-MPDU action
1834 * 	The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
1835 * 	the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
1836 * 	ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action. Starting sequence number (@ssn)
1837 * 	is the first frame we expect to perform the action on. Notice
1838 * 	that TX/RX_STOP can pass NULL for this parameter.
1839 *	The @buf_size parameter is only valid when the action is set to
1840 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL and indicates the peer's reorder
1841 *	buffer size (number of subframes) for this session -- the driver
1842 *	may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than this
1843 *	nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
1844 *	buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
1845 *	possible with a buf_size of 8:
1846 *	 - TX: 1.....7
1847 *	 - RX:  2....7 (lost frame #1)
1848 *	 - TX:        8..1...
1849 *	which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
1850 *	buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
1851 *	 - TX:       1 or 18 or 81
1852 *	Even "189" would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
1853 *
1854 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
1855 *	The callback can sleep.
1856 *
1857 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
1858 *
1859 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
1860 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
1861 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
1862 *	The callback can sleep.
1863 *
1864 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
1865 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
1866 *	accordingly. This callback is not required and may sleep.
 
 
1867 *
1868 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command.
1869 *	The callback can sleep.
1870 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
1871 *
1872 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
1873 *	that the hardware queues are empty. If the parameter @drop is set
1874 *	to %true, pending frames may be dropped. The callback can sleep.
 
 
 
 
1875 *
1876 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
1877 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
1878 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
1879 *	completion of the channel switch.
1880 *
1881 * @napi_poll: Poll Rx queue for incoming data frames.
1882 *
1883 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
1884 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
1885 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
1886 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
1887 *
1888 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
1889 *
1890 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
1891 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
1892 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
1893 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
1894 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
1895 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
1896 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(). This callback may sleep.
 
 
 
1897 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
1898 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
1899 * @offchannel_tx: Transmit frame on another channel, wait for a response
1900 *	and return. Reliable TX status must be reported for the frame. If the
1901 *	return value is 1, then the @remain_on_channel will be used with a
1902 *	regular transmission (if supported.)
1903 * @offchannel_tx_cancel_wait: cancel wait associated with offchannel TX
1904 *
1905 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
1906 *
1907 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
1908 *
1909 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
1910 *	queues before entering power save.
1911 *
1912 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
1913 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
1914 *	The callback can sleep.
1915 * @rssi_callback: Notify driver when the average RSSI goes above/below
1916 *	thresholds that were registered previously. The callback can sleep.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1917 */
1918struct ieee80211_ops {
1919	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
 
 
1920	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
1921	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
1922#ifdef CONFIG_PM
1923	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
1924	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
1925#endif
1926	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1927			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1928	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1929				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1930				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
1931	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1932				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1933	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
1934	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1935				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1936				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
1937				 u32 changed);
1938
1939	int (*tx_sync)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1940		       const u8 *bssid, enum ieee80211_tx_sync_type type);
1941	void (*finish_tx_sync)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1942			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1943			       const u8 *bssid,
1944			       enum ieee80211_tx_sync_type type);
1945
1946	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1947				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
1948	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1949				 unsigned int changed_flags,
1950				 unsigned int *total_flags,
1951				 u64 multicast);
 
 
 
 
1952	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
1953		       bool set);
1954	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
1955		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
1956		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
1957	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1958				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1959				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
1960				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
1961				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
1962	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1963			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1964			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
 
 
1965	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1966		       struct cfg80211_scan_request *req);
1967	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1968			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1969	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1970				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1971				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
1972				struct ieee80211_sched_scan_ies *ies);
1973	void (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1974			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1975	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
1976	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
 
 
1977	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1978			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
1979	void (*get_tkip_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 hw_key_idx,
1980			     u32 *iv32, u16 *iv16);
 
1981	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
1982	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
1983	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1984		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
1985	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1986			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
 
 
 
 
 
 
1987	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1988			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
1989	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u16 queue,
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1990		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
1991	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
1992	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u64 tsf);
1993	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
 
 
1994	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1995	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
1996			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
1997			    enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action,
1998			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid, u16 *ssn,
1999			    u8 buf_size);
2000	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
2001		struct survey_info *survey);
2002	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2003	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 coverage_class);
2004#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
2005	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *data, int len);
 
2006	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
2007			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
2008			     void *data, int len);
2009#endif
2010	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool drop);
 
2011	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
 
2012			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
2013	int (*napi_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int budget);
2014	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
2015	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
2016
2017	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
 
2018				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
2019				 enum nl80211_channel_type channel_type,
2020				 int duration);
2021	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2022	int (*offchannel_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
2023			     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
2024			     enum nl80211_channel_type channel_type,
2025			     unsigned int wait);
2026	int (*offchannel_tx_cancel_wait)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2027	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
2028	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2029			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
2030	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2031	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2032				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
2033	void (*rssi_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2034			      enum ieee80211_rssi_event rssi_event);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2035};
2036
2037/**
2038 * ieee80211_alloc_hw -  Allocate a new hardware device
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2039 *
2040 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
2041 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
2042 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
2043 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
2044 * @priv_data_len.
2045 *
2046 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
2047 * @ops: callbacks for this device
 
 
2048 */
 
2049struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
2050					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops);
 
 
 
2051
2052/**
2053 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
2054 *
2055 * You must call this function before any other functions in
2056 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
2057 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
2058 *
2059 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 
 
2060 */
2061int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2062
2063/**
2064 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
2065 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
2066 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
2067 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
2068 */
2069struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
2070	int throughput;
2071	int blink_time;
2072};
2073
2074/**
2075 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
2076 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
2077 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
2078 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
2079 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
2080 */
2081enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
2082	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
2083	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
2084	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
2085};
2086
2087#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2088extern char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2089extern char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2090extern char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2091extern char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2092extern char *__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(
2093				struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
2094				const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
2095				unsigned int blink_table_len);
 
2096#endif
2097/**
2098 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
2099 *
2100 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
2101 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
2102 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
2103 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
2104 *
2105 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 
 
2106 */
2107static inline char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
2108{
2109#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2110	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
2111#else
2112	return NULL;
2113#endif
2114}
2115
2116/**
2117 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
2118 *
2119 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
2120 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
2121 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
2122 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
2123 *
2124 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 
 
2125 */
2126static inline char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
2127{
2128#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2129	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
2130#else
2131	return NULL;
2132#endif
2133}
2134
2135/**
2136 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
2137 *
2138 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
2139 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
2140 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
2141 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
2142 *
2143 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 
 
2144 */
2145static inline char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
2146{
2147#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2148	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
2149#else
2150	return NULL;
2151#endif
2152}
2153
2154/**
2155 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
2156 *
2157 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
2158 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
2159 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
2160 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
2161 *
2162 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
 
 
2163 */
2164static inline char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
2165{
2166#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2167	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
2168#else
2169	return NULL;
2170#endif
2171}
2172
2173/**
2174 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
2175 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
2176 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
2177 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
2178 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
2179 *
2180 * This function returns %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED
2181 * triggers are configured) or the name of the new trigger.
2182 * This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
 
2183 */
2184static inline char *
2185ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
2186				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
2187				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
2188{
2189#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
2190	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
2191						  blink_table_len);
2192#else
2193	return NULL;
2194#endif
2195}
2196
2197/**
2198 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
2199 *
2200 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
2201 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
2202 *
2203 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
2204 */
2205void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2206
2207/**
2208 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
2209 *
2210 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
2211 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
2212 * before calling this function.
2213 *
2214 * @hw: the hardware to free
2215 */
2216void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2217
2218/**
2219 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
2220 *
2221 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
2222 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
2223 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
2224 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
2225 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
2226 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
2227 *
2228 * @hw: the hardware to restart
2229 */
2230void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2231
2232/** ieee80211_napi_schedule - schedule NAPI poll
 
2233 *
2234 * Use this function to schedule NAPI polling on a device.
 
 
 
 
2235 *
2236 * @hw: the hardware to start polling
2237 */
2238void ieee80211_napi_schedule(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2239
2240/** ieee80211_napi_complete - complete NAPI polling
2241 *
2242 * Use this function to finish NAPI polling on a device.
2243 *
2244 * @hw: the hardware to stop polling
 
 
 
2245 */
2246void ieee80211_napi_complete(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
2247
2248/**
2249 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
2250 *
2251 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
2252 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
2253 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
2254 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
2255 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
2256 *
2257 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
2258 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
2259 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
2260 * mixed for a single hardware.
 
2261 *
2262 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
2263 *
2264 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
2265 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
2266 */
2267void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
 
 
 
2268
2269/**
2270 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
2271 *
2272 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
2273 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
2274 *
2275 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
2276 * be mixed for a single hardware.
 
2277 *
2278 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
2279 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
2280 */
2281void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2282
2283/**
2284 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
2285 *
2286 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
2287 * (internally disables bottom halves).
2288 *
2289 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
2290 * not be mixed for a single hardware.
 
2291 *
2292 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
2293 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
2294 */
2295static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2296				   struct sk_buff *skb)
2297{
2298	local_bh_disable();
2299	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
2300	local_bh_enable();
2301}
2302
2303/**
2304 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
2305 *
2306 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
2307 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
2308 * entering/leaving PS mode.
2309 *
2310 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
2311 *
2312 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
2313 * each other.
2314 *
2315 * The function returns -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
2316 *
2317 * @sta: currently connected sta
2318 * @start: start or stop PS
 
 
2319 */
2320int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
2321
2322/**
2323 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
2324 *                                  (in process context)
2325 *
2326 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
2327 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
2328 * applies.
2329 *
2330 * @sta: currently connected sta
2331 * @start: start or stop PS
 
 
2332 */
2333static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
2334						  bool start)
2335{
2336	int ret;
2337
2338	local_bh_disable();
2339	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
2340	local_bh_enable();
2341
2342	return ret;
2343}
2344
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2345/*
2346 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
2347 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
2348 */
2349#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	13
2350
2351/**
2352 * ieee80211_sta_set_tim - set the TIM bit for a sleeping station
2353 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
 
 
2354 *
2355 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
2356 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station needs to be told
2357 * to wake up using the TIM bitmap in the beacon.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2358 *
2359 * This function sets the station's TIM bit - it will be cleared when the
2360 * station wakes up.
2361 */
2362void ieee80211_sta_set_tim(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
 
2363
2364/**
2365 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
2366 *
2367 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
2368 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
2369 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
2370 *
2371 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
2372 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
2373 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
2374 * may not be mixed for a single hardware.
 
2375 *
2376 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
2377 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
2378 */
2379void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2380			 struct sk_buff *skb);
2381
2382/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2383 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
2384 *
2385 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
2386 *
2387 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
2388 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
2389 * for a single hardware.
2390 *
2391 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
2392 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
2393 */
2394static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2395					  struct sk_buff *skb)
2396{
2397	local_bh_disable();
2398	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
2399	local_bh_enable();
2400}
2401
2402/**
2403 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
2404 *
2405 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
2406 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
2407 *
2408 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
2409 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
2410 *
2411 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
2412 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
2413 */
2414void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2415				 struct sk_buff *skb);
2416
2417/**
2418 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
2419 *
2420 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
2421 * connected STA.
2422 *
2423 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
2424 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
2425 */
2426void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
2427
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2428/**
2429 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
2430 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2431 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2432 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
2433 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
2434 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
2435 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
2436 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
2437 *
2438 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
2439 * obtain the beacon frame/template.
2440 *
2441 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
2442 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
2443 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function
2444 * before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
2445 *
2446 * If the beacon frames are generated by the device, then the driver
2447 * must use the returned beacon as the template and change the TIM IE
2448 * according to the current DTIM parameters/TIM bitmap.
2449 *
2450 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
 
 
2451 */
2452struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2453					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2454					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length);
2455
2456/**
2457 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
2458 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2459 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2460 *
2461 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
 
 
2462 */
2463static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2464						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2465{
2466	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL);
2467}
2468
2469/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2470 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
2471 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2472 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2473 *
2474 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
2475 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
2476 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
2477 *
2478 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
2479 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
 
 
2480 */
2481struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2482				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2483
2484/**
2485 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
2486 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2487 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
 
2488 *
2489 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
2490 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
2491 * BSSID and address is used.
2492 *
 
 
 
2493 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
2494 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
 
 
2495 */
2496struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2497				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
2498
2499/**
2500 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
2501 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2502 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2503 * @ssid: SSID buffer
2504 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
2505 * @ie: buffer containing all IEs except SSID for the template
2506 * @ie_len: length of the IE buffer
2507 *
2508 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
2509 * hardware.
 
 
2510 */
2511struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2512				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2513				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
2514				       const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len);
2515
2516/**
2517 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
2518 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2519 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2520 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
2521 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
2522 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
2523 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
2524 *
2525 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
2526 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
2527 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
2528 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
2529 */
2530void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2531		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
2532		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
2533		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
2534
2535/**
2536 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
2537 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2538 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2539 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
2540 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
2541 *
2542 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
2543 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
2544 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
 
 
2545 */
2546__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2547			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
2548			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
2549
2550/**
2551 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
2552 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2553 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2554 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
2555 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
2556 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
2557 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
2558 *
2559 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
2560 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
2561 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
2562 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
2563 */
2564void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2565			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2566			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
2567			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
2568			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
2569
2570/**
2571 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
2572 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2573 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2574 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
2575 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
2576 *
2577 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
2578 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
2579 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
 
 
2580 */
2581__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2582				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2583				    size_t frame_len,
2584				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
2585
2586/**
2587 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
2588 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2589 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
2590 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
2591 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
2592 *
2593 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
2594 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
 
 
2595 */
2596__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2597					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
 
2598					size_t frame_len,
2599					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
2600
2601/**
2602 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
2603 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2604 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2605 *
2606 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
2607 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
2608 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
2609 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
2610 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame. This
2611 * function returns a pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more
2612 * buffered frames are available.
 
2613 *
2614 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
2615 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
2616 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
2617 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
2618 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
2619 * use common code for all beacons.
2620 */
2621struct sk_buff *
2622ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2623
2624/**
2625 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
2626 *
2627 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
2628 *
2629 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2630 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
2631 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
2632 */
2633void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2634			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
2635
2636/**
2637 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
2638 *
2639 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
2640 * from the given packet.
2641 *
2642 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2643 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
2644 *	with this P1K
2645 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
2646 */
2647static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2648					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
2649{
2650	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
2651	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
2652	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
2653
2654	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
2655}
2656
2657/**
2658 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
2659 *
2660 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
2661 * and transmitter address.
2662 *
2663 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2664 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
2665 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
2666 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
2667 */
2668void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2669			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
2670
2671/**
2672 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
2673 *
2674 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
2675 * in the packet.
2676 *
2677 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2678 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
2679 *	encrypted with this key
2680 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
2681 */
2682void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2683			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
2684
2685/**
2686 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2687 *
2688 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2689 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2690 *	reverse order than in packet)
2691 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2692 *	reverse order than in packet)
2693 */
2694struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2695	union {
2696		struct {
2697			u32 iv32;
2698			u16 iv16;
2699		} tkip;
2700		struct {
2701			u8 pn[6];
2702		} ccmp;
2703		struct {
2704			u8 pn[6];
2705		} aes_cmac;
2706	};
2707};
2708
2709/**
2710 * ieee80211_get_key_tx_seq - get key TX sequence counter
2711 *
 
2712 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2713 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
 
 
 
2714 *
2715 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current TX IV/PN
2716 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV generation is
2717 * offloaded to the device.
2718 *
2719 * Note that this function may only be called when no TX processing
2720 * can be done concurrently, for example when queues are stopped
2721 * and the stop has been synchronized.
2722 */
2723void ieee80211_get_key_tx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2724			      struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
2725
2726/**
2727 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
2728 *
2729 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
2730 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP only);
2731 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
2732 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
2733 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
2734 *
2735 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
2736 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
2737 * by the device and not by mac80211.
2738 *
2739 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
2740 * can be done concurrently.
2741 */
2742void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
2743			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
2744
2745/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2746 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
2747 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
2748 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
2749 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
2750 * @gfp: allocation flags
2751 */
2752void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
2753				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
2754
2755/**
2756 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
2757 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2758 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
2759 *
2760 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
2761 */
2762void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
2763
2764/**
2765 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
2766 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2767 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
2768 *
2769 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
2770 */
2771void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
2772
2773/**
2774 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
2775 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2776 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
2777 *
2778 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
 
 
2779 */
2780
2781int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
2782
2783/**
2784 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
2785 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2786 *
2787 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
2788 */
2789void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2790
2791/**
2792 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
2793 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
2794 *
2795 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
2796 */
2797void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2798
2799/**
2800 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
2801 *
2802 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
2803 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
2804 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
2805 * any context, including hardirq context.
2806 *
2807 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
2808 * @aborted: set to true if scan was aborted
2809 */
2810void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool aborted);
 
2811
2812/**
2813 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
2814 *
2815 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
2816 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
2817 *
2818 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
2819 */
2820void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2821
2822/**
2823 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
2824 *
2825 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
2826 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
2827 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
2828 * while associating, for instance.
2829 *
2830 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
2831 */
2832void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
2833
2834/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2835 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
2836 *
2837 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
2838 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
2839 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
2840 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
2841 * be used.
2842 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface()
2843 *
2844 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 
2845 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
2846 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
2847 */
2848void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2849					 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
2850						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
2851					 void *data);
 
 
 
 
 
 
2852
2853/**
2854 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
2855 *
2856 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
2857 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
2858 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
2859 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
2860 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface()
2861 *
2862 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
 
2863 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
2864 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
2865 */
2866void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
 
2867						void (*iterator)(void *data,
2868						    u8 *mac,
2869						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
2870						void *data);
2871
2872/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2873 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
2874 *
2875 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
2876 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
2877 *
2878 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
2879 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
2880 */
2881void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
2882
2883/**
2884 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
2885 *
2886 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
2887 * workqueue.
2888 *
2889 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
2890 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
2891 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
2892 */
2893void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2894				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
2895				  unsigned long delay);
2896
2897/**
2898 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
2899 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
2900 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
2901 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
2902 *
2903 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
2904 *
2905 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
2906 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
2907 * will be managed by the mac80211.
2908 */
2909int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
2910				  u16 timeout);
2911
2912/**
2913 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
2914 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
2915 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
2916 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
2917 *
2918 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
2919 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
2920 * from any context.
2921 */
2922void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
2923				      u16 tid);
2924
2925/**
2926 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
2927 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
2928 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
2929 *
2930 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
2931 *
2932 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
2933 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
2934 * will be managed by the mac80211.
2935 */
2936int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
2937
2938/**
2939 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
2940 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
2941 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
2942 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
2943 *
2944 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
2945 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
2946 * can be called from any context.
2947 */
2948void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
2949				     u16 tid);
2950
2951/**
2952 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
2953 *
2954 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
2955 * @addr: station's address
2956 *
2957 * This function must be called under RCU lock and the
 
 
2958 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
2959 */
2960struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2961					 const u8 *addr);
2962
2963/**
2964 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
2965 *
2966 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
2967 * @addr: remote station's address
2968 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
2969 *
2970 * This function must be called under RCU lock and the
 
 
2971 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
2972 *
2973 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
2974 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
2975 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
2976 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
2977 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
2978 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
2979 *      is not reliable.
2980 *
2981 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
2982 */
2983struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2984					       const u8 *addr,
2985					       const u8 *localaddr);
2986
2987/**
2988 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
2989 * @hw: the hardware
2990 * @pubsta: the station
2991 * @block: whether to block or unblock
2992 *
2993 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
2994 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
2995 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
2996 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
2997 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
2998 *
2999 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
3000 * manner.
3001 *
3002 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
3003 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
3004 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
3005 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
3006 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
3007 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
3008 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
3009 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
3010 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
3011 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
3012 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
3013 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
3014 * woke up while blocked or not.
3015 */
3016void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3017			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
3018
3019/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3020 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
3021 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
3022 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
3023 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
3024 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
3025 *
3026 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
3027 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
3028 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
3029 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
3030 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
3031 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
3032 *
3033 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
3034 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
3035 * set_key callback.
3036 */
3037void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3038			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3039			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3040				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3041				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3042				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
3043				      void *data),
3044			 void *iter_data);
3045
3046/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3047 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
3048 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
3049 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3050 *
3051 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
3052 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
3053 * information. This function must only be called from within the
3054 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
3055 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
3056 * NULL.
 
 
3057 */
3058struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3059					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3060
3061/**
3062 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
3063 *
3064 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3065 *
3066 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER and
3067 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
3068 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
3069 */
3070void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3071
3072/**
3073 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
3074 *
3075 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3076 *
3077 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_FILTER, and
3078 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
3079 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
 
 
3080 *
3081 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
3082 * without connection recovery attempts.
3083 */
3084void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3085
3086/**
3087 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
3088 *
3089 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3090 *
3091 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
3092 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
3093 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
3094 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
3095 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
3096 *
3097 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
3098 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
3099 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
3100 * disconnect normally later.
3101 *
3102 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
3103 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
3104 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
3105 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
3106 */
3107void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3108
3109/**
3110 * ieee80211_disable_dyn_ps - force mac80211 to temporarily disable dynamic psm
3111 *
3112 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3113 *
3114 * Some hardware require full power save to manage simultaneous BT traffic
3115 * on the WLAN frequency. Full PSM is required periodically, whenever there are
3116 * burst of BT traffic. The hardware gets information of BT traffic via
3117 * hardware co-existence lines, and consequentially requests mac80211 to
3118 * (temporarily) enter full psm.
3119 * This function will only temporarily disable dynamic PS, not enable PSM if
3120 * it was not already enabled.
3121 * The driver must make sure to re-enable dynamic PS using
3122 * ieee80211_enable_dyn_ps() if the driver has disabled it.
3123 *
3124 */
3125void ieee80211_disable_dyn_ps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3126
3127/**
3128 * ieee80211_enable_dyn_ps - restore dynamic psm after being disabled
3129 *
3130 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3131 *
3132 * This function restores dynamic PS after being temporarily disabled via
3133 * ieee80211_disable_dyn_ps(). Each ieee80211_disable_dyn_ps() call must
3134 * be coupled with an eventual call to this function.
3135 *
3136 */
3137void ieee80211_enable_dyn_ps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3138
3139/**
3140 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
3141 *	rssi threshold triggered
3142 *
3143 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3144 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
 
3145 * @gfp: context flags
3146 *
3147 * When the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
3148 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
3149 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
3150 */
3151void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3152			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
 
3153			       gfp_t gfp);
3154
3155/**
3156 * ieee80211_get_operstate - get the operstate of the vif
3157 *
3158 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
 
 
 
 
 
 
3159 *
3160 * The driver might need to know the operstate of the net_device
3161 * (specifically, whether the link is IF_OPER_UP after resume)
3162 */
3163unsigned char ieee80211_get_operstate(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3164
3165/**
3166 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
3167 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3168 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
3169 *
3170 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
3171 * and wake up the suspended queues.
3172 */
3173void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
3174
3175/**
3176 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
3177 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3178 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
3179 *
3180 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
3181 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
3182 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
3183 */
3184void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3185			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
3186
3187/**
3188 * ieee80211_key_removed - disable hw acceleration for key
3189 * @key_conf: The key hw acceleration should be disabled for
3190 *
3191 * This allows drivers to indicate that the given key has been
3192 * removed from hardware acceleration, due to a new key that
3193 * was added. Don't use this if the key can continue to be used
3194 * for TX, if the key restriction is on RX only it is permitted
3195 * to keep the key for TX only and not call this function.
3196 *
3197 * Due to locking constraints, it may only be called during
3198 * @set_key. This function must be allowed to sleep, and the
3199 * key it tries to disable may still be used until it returns.
3200 */
3201void ieee80211_key_removed(struct ieee80211_key_conf *key_conf);
3202
3203/**
3204 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
3205 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
3206 */
3207void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3208
3209/**
3210 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
3211 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
3212 */
3213void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3214
3215/**
3216 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
3217 *
3218 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
3219 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
3220 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
3221 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
3222 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
3223 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
3224 *
3225 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
3226 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
3227 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
3228 */
3229void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
3230				  const u8 *addr);
3231
3232/* Rate control API */
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3233
3234/**
3235 * enum rate_control_changed - flags to indicate which parameter changed
 
 
 
3236 *
3237 * @IEEE80211_RC_HT_CHANGED: The HT parameters of the operating channel have
3238 *	changed, rate control algorithm can update its internal state if needed.
 
 
3239 */
3240enum rate_control_changed {
3241	IEEE80211_RC_HT_CHANGED = BIT(0)
3242};
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3243
3244/**
3245 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
3246 *
3247 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
3248 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
3249 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
 
 
3250 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
3251 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
3252 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
3253 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
3254 *	RTS threshold
3255 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
3256 *	if the selected rate supports it
3257 * @max_rate_idx: user-requested maximum rate (not MCS for now)
3258 *	(deprecated; this will be removed once drivers get updated to use
3259 *	rate_idx_mask)
3260 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested rate mask (not MCS for now)
3261 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
3262 *	to be filled in
3263 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
3264 */
3265struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
3266	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
3267	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
3268	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
3269	struct sk_buff *skb;
3270	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
3271	bool rts, short_preamble;
3272	u8 max_rate_idx;
3273	u32 rate_idx_mask;
 
3274	bool bss;
3275};
3276
3277struct rate_control_ops {
3278	struct module *module;
3279	const char *name;
3280	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct dentry *debugfsdir);
3281	void (*free)(void *priv);
3282
3283	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
3284	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
 
3285			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
3286	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
3287			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3288			    void *priv_sta, u32 changed,
3289			    enum nl80211_channel_type oper_chan_type);
3290	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3291			 void *priv_sta);
3292
 
 
 
3293	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
3294			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
3295			  struct sk_buff *skb);
3296	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
3297			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
3298
3299	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
3300				struct dentry *dir);
3301	void (*remove_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta);
 
 
3302};
3303
3304static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3305				 enum ieee80211_band band,
3306				 int index)
3307{
3308	return (sta == NULL || sta->supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
3309}
3310
3311/**
3312 * rate_control_send_low - helper for drivers for management/no-ack frames
3313 *
3314 * Rate control algorithms that agree to use the lowest rate to
3315 * send management frames and NO_ACK data with the respective hw
3316 * retries should use this in the beginning of their mac80211 get_rate
3317 * callback. If true is returned the rate control can simply return.
3318 * If false is returned we guarantee that sta and sta and priv_sta is
3319 * not null.
3320 *
3321 * Rate control algorithms wishing to do more intelligent selection of
3322 * rate for multicast/broadcast frames may choose to not use this.
3323 *
3324 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. Note
3325 * 	that this may be null.
3326 * @priv_sta: private rate control structure. This may be null.
3327 * @txrc: rate control information we sholud populate for mac80211.
3328 */
3329bool rate_control_send_low(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3330			   void *priv_sta,
3331			   struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
3332
3333
3334static inline s8
3335rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
3336		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
3337{
3338	int i;
3339
3340	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
3341		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
3342			return i;
3343
3344	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
3345	WARN_ON(1);
3346
 
3347	return 0;
3348}
3349
3350static inline
3351bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
3352			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
3353{
3354	unsigned int i;
3355
3356	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
3357		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
3358			return true;
3359	return false;
3360}
3361
3362int ieee80211_rate_control_register(struct rate_control_ops *ops);
3363void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(struct rate_control_ops *ops);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3364
3365static inline bool
3366conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3367{
3368	return conf->channel_type == NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
3369}
3370
3371static inline bool
3372conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3373{
3374	return conf->channel_type == NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
 
3375}
3376
3377static inline bool
3378conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3379{
3380	return conf->channel_type == NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
 
3381}
3382
3383static inline bool
3384conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3385{
3386	return conf_is_ht40_minus(conf) || conf_is_ht40_plus(conf);
3387}
3388
3389static inline bool
3390conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
3391{
3392	return conf->channel_type != NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
 
 
3393}
3394
3395static inline enum nl80211_iftype
3396ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
3397{
3398	if (p2p) {
3399		switch (type) {
3400		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
3401			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
3402		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
3403			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
3404		default:
3405			break;
3406		}
3407	}
3408	return type;
3409}
3410
3411static inline enum nl80211_iftype
3412ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
3413{
3414	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
3415}
3416
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3417void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3418				   int rssi_min_thold,
3419				   int rssi_max_thold);
3420
3421void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3422#endif /* MAC80211_H */
v4.17
   1/*
   2 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
   3 *
   4 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
   5 * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
   6 * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
   7 * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
   8 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
   9 * Copyright (C) 2018        Intel Corporation
  10 *
  11 * This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
  12 * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License version 2 as
  13 * published by the Free Software Foundation.
  14 */
  15
  16#ifndef MAC80211_H
  17#define MAC80211_H
  18
  19#include <linux/bug.h>
  20#include <linux/kernel.h>
  21#include <linux/if_ether.h>
  22#include <linux/skbuff.h>
 
 
  23#include <linux/ieee80211.h>
  24#include <net/cfg80211.h>
  25#include <net/codel.h>
  26#include <asm/unaligned.h>
  27
  28/**
  29 * DOC: Introduction
  30 *
  31 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
  32 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
  33 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
  34 * drivers.
  35 */
  36
  37/**
  38 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
  39 *
  40 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
  41 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
  42 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
  43 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
  44 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
  45 * tasklet function.
  46 *
  47 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
  48 *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
  49 */
  50
  51/**
  52 * DOC: Warning
  53 *
  54 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
  55 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
  56 */
  57
  58/**
  59 * DOC: Frame format
  60 *
  61 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
  62 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
  63 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
  64 * hardware.
  65 *
  66 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
  67 *
  68 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
  69 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
  70 *
  71 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
  72 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
 
 
 
 
  73 */
  74
  75/**
  76 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
  77 *
  78 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
  79 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
  80 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
  81 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
  82 *
  83 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
  84 * suspend.
  85 *
  86 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
  87 *
  88 */
  89
  90/**
  91 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
  92 *
  93 * mac80211 provides an optional intermediate queueing implementation designed
  94 * to allow the driver to keep hardware queues short and provide some fairness
  95 * between different stations/interfaces.
  96 * In this model, the driver pulls data frames from the mac80211 queue instead
  97 * of letting mac80211 push them via drv_tx().
  98 * Other frames (e.g. control or management) are still pushed using drv_tx().
  99 *
 100 * Drivers indicate that they use this model by implementing the .wake_tx_queue
 101 * driver operation.
 102 *
 103 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with a
 104 * single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
 105 *
 106 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
 107 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
 108 *
 109 * The driver can't access the queue directly. To dequeue a frame, it calls
 110 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it
 111 * calls the .wake_tx_queue driver op.
 112 *
 113 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
 114 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
 115 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
 116 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
 117 * .release_buffered_frames().
 118 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
 119 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
 120 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
 121 */
 122
 123struct device;
 124
 125/**
 126 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
 127 *
 128 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
 129 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
 130 */
 131enum ieee80211_max_queues {
 132	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
 133	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
 134};
 135
 136#define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
 137
 138/**
 139 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
 140 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
 141 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
 142 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
 143 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
 144 */
 145enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
 146	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
 147	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
 148	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
 149	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
 150};
 151
 152/**
 153 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
 154 *
 155 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
 156 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
 157 *
 158 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
 159 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
 160 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
 161 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
 162 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
 163 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
 164 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
 165 */
 166struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
 167	u16 txop;
 168	u16 cw_min;
 169	u16 cw_max;
 170	u8 aifs;
 171	bool acm;
 172	bool uapsd;
 173};
 174
 175struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
 176	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
 177	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
 178	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
 179	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
 180};
 181
 182/**
 183 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
 184 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
 185 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
 186 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
 187 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
 188 *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
 189 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
 190 */
 191enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
 192	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
 193	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
 194	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
 195	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
 196	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
 197};
 198
 199/**
 200 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
 201 *
 202 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
 203 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
 204 *
 205 * @def: the channel definition
 206 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
 207 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
 208 *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
 209 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
 210 *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
 211 *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
 212 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
 213 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
 214 *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
 215 */
 216struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
 217	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
 218	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
 219
 220	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
 221
 222	bool radar_enabled;
 223
 224	u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
 225};
 226
 227/**
 228 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
 229 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
 230 *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
 231 *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
 232 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
 233 *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
 234 *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
 235 *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
 236 *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
 237 *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
 238 *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
 239 *      for changes/removal.)
 240 */
 241enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
 242	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
 243	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
 244};
 245
 246/**
 247 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
 248 *
 249 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
 250 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
 251 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
 252 * done.
 253 *
 254 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
 255 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
 256 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
 257 */
 258struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
 259	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 260	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
 261	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
 262};
 263
 264/**
 265 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
 266 *
 267 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed() callback
 268 * to indicate which BSS parameter changed.
 269 *
 270 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
 271 *	also implies a change in the AID.
 272 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
 273 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
 274 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
 275 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
 276 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
 277 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
 278 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
 279 *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
 280 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
 281 *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
 282 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
 283 *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
 284 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
 285 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
 286 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
 287 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
 288 *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
 289 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
 290 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
 291 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
 292 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
 293 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
 294 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
 295 *	changed
 296 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
 297 *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
 298 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
 299 *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
 300 *	context had been assigned.
 301 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
 302 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
 303 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
 304 *	keep alive) changed.
 305 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
 306 *
 307 */
 308enum ieee80211_bss_change {
 309	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
 310	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
 311	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
 312	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
 313	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
 314	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
 315	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
 316	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
 317	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
 318	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
 319	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
 320	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
 321	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
 322	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
 323	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
 324	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
 325	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
 326	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
 327	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
 328	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
 329	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
 330	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
 331	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
 332	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
 333	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
 334	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
 335
 336	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
 337};
 338
 339/*
 340 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
 341 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
 342 * filtering will be disabled.
 343 */
 344#define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
 345
 346/**
 347 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
 348 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
 349 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
 350 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
 351 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
 352 *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
 353 *	once each time the timeout triggers.
 354 */
 355enum ieee80211_event_type {
 356	RSSI_EVENT,
 357	MLME_EVENT,
 358	BAR_RX_EVENT,
 359	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
 360};
 361
 362/**
 363 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
 364 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
 365 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
 366 */
 367enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
 368	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
 369	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
 370};
 371
 372/**
 373 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
 374 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
 375 */
 376struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
 377	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
 378};
 379
 380/**
 381 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 382 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
 383 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
 384 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
 385 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
 386 */
 387enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
 388	AUTH_EVENT,
 389	ASSOC_EVENT,
 390	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
 391	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
 392};
 393
 394/**
 395 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
 396 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
 397 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
 398 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
 399 */
 400enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
 401	MLME_SUCCESS,
 402	MLME_DENIED,
 403	MLME_TIMEOUT,
 404};
 405
 406/**
 407 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
 408 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
 409 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
 410 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
 411 */
 412struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
 413	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
 414	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
 415	u16 reason;
 416};
 417
 418/**
 419 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
 420 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
 421 * @tid: the tid
 422 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
 423 */
 424struct ieee80211_ba_event {
 425	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 426	u16 tid;
 427	u16 ssn;
 428};
 429
 430/**
 431 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
 432 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
 433 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
 434 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
 435 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
 436 * @u:union holding the fields above
 437 */
 438struct ieee80211_event {
 439	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
 440	union {
 441		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
 442		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
 443		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
 444	} u;
 445};
 446
 447/**
 448 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
 449 *
 450 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
 451 *
 452 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
 453 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
 454 */
 455struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
 456	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
 457	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
 458};
 459
 460/**
 461 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
 462 *
 463 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
 464 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
 465 *
 466 * @assoc: association status
 467 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS
 468 *	or not
 469 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
 470 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
 471 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
 472 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
 473 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
 
 
 
 
 474 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
 475 *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
 476 *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
 477 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
 478 *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
 479 *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
 480 *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
 481 *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
 482 *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 483 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
 484 *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
 485 *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
 486 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
 487 *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
 488 *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
 489 *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
 490 *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
 491 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
 492 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
 493 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
 494 *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
 495 *	the current band.
 496 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
 497 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
 498 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
 499 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
 500 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
 501 *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
 502 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
 503 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
 504 *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
 505 *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
 506 *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
 507 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
 508 *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
 509 *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
 510 *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
 511 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
 512 *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
 513 *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
 514 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
 515 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
 516 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
 517 *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
 518 *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
 519 *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
 520 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
 521 *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
 522 *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
 
 
 523 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
 524 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
 525 *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
 526 *	your driver/device needs to do.
 527 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
 528 *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
 529 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
 530 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
 531 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
 532 * @txpower: TX power in dBm
 533 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
 534 *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
 535 *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
 536 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
 537 *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
 538 *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
 539 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
 540 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
 541 *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
 542 *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
 543 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
 544 *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
 545 *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
 546 *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
 547 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
 548 *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
 549 *	station.
 550 */
 551struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
 552	const u8 *bssid;
 553	/* association related data */
 554	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
 555	bool ibss_creator;
 556	u16 aid;
 557	/* erp related data */
 558	bool use_cts_prot;
 559	bool use_short_preamble;
 560	bool use_short_slot;
 561	bool enable_beacon;
 562	u8 dtim_period;
 563	u16 beacon_int;
 564	u16 assoc_capability;
 565	u64 sync_tsf;
 566	u32 sync_device_ts;
 567	u8 sync_dtim_count;
 568	u32 basic_rates;
 569	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
 570	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 571	u16 ht_operation_mode;
 572	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
 573	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
 574	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
 575	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
 576	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
 577	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
 578	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
 579	int arp_addr_cnt;
 
 580	bool qos;
 581	bool idle;
 582	bool ps;
 583	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
 584	size_t ssid_len;
 585	bool hidden_ssid;
 586	int txpower;
 587	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
 588	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
 589	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
 590	u16 max_idle_period;
 591	bool protected_keep_alive;
 592};
 593
 594/**
 595 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
 596 *
 597 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
 598 *
 599 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
 600 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
 601 *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
 602 *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
 603 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
 604 *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
 605 *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
 606 *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
 607 *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
 608 *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
 609 *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
 610 *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
 611 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
 612 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
 613 *	station
 614 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
 615 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
 616 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
 617 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
 618 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
 619 *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
 620 *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
 621 *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
 622 *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
 623 *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
 624 *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
 625 *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
 626 *	hardware queue.
 627 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
 628 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
 629 * 	is for the whole aggregation.
 630 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
 631 * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
 632 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
 633 *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
 634 *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
 635 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
 636 *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
 637 *	off-channel operation.
 638 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
 639 *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
 640 *	it can be sent out.
 641 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
 642 *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
 643 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
 644 *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
 645 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
 646 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
 647 *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
 648 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
 649 *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
 650 *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
 651 *	queue gets full.
 652 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
 653 *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
 654 *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
 655 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
 656 *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
 657 *	should kick the MLME state machine.
 658 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
 659 *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
 660 *	status to user space)
 661 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
 662 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
 663 *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
 664 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
 665 *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
 666 *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
 667 *	handled properly by the device.
 668 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
 669 *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
 670 *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
 671 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
 672 *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
 673 *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
 674 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
 675 *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
 676 *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
 677 *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
 678 *	PS-Poll responses.
 679 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
 680 *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
 681 *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
 682 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
 683 *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
 684 *	monitor injection).
 685 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
 686 *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
 687 *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
 688 *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
 689 *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
 690 *
 691 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
 692 *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
 693 */
 694enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
 695	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
 696	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
 697	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
 698	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
 699	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
 700	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
 701	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
 702	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
 703	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
 704	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
 705	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
 706	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
 707	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
 708	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
 709	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(14),
 710	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
 711	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
 712	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
 713	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
 714	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
 715	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
 716	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
 717	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
 718	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
 719	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
 720	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
 721	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
 722	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
 723	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
 724	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
 725	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
 726};
 727
 728#define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
 729
 730/**
 731 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
 732 *
 733 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
 734 *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
 735 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
 736 *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
 737 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
 738 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
 739 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
 740 *
 741 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
 742 */
 743enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
 744	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
 745	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
 746	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
 747	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
 748	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
 749};
 750
 751/*
 752 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
 753 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
 754 */
 755#define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
 756	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
 757	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
 758	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
 759	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
 760	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
 761	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
 762	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
 763
 764/**
 765 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
 766 *	Rate Control algorithm.
 767 *
 768 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
 769 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
 770 *
 771 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
 772 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
 773 *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
 774 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
 775 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
 776 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
 777 *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
 778 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
 779 *	Greenfield mode.
 780 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
 781 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
 782 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
 783 *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
 784 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
 785 *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
 786 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
 787 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
 788 */
 789enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
 790	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
 791	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
 792	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
 793
 794	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
 795	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
 796	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
 797	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
 798	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
 799	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
 800	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
 801	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
 802	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
 803};
 804
 805
 806/* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
 807#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
 808
 809/* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
 810#define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
 811
 812/* maximum number of rate stages */
 813#define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
 814
 815/* maximum number of rate table entries */
 816#define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
 817
 818/**
 819 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
 820 *
 821 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
 822 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
 823 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
 824 *
 825 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
 826 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
 827 *
 828 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
 829 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
 830 *
 831 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
 832 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
 833 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
 834 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
 835 * information::
 836 *
 837 *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
 838 *
 839 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
 840 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
 841 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
 842 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
 843 * information should then contain::
 844 *
 845 *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
 846 *
 847 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
 848 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
 849 */
 850struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
 851	s8 idx;
 852	u16 count:5,
 853	    flags:11;
 854} __packed;
 855
 856#define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
 857
 858static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
 859					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
 860{
 861	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
 862	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
 863	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
 864}
 865
 866static inline u8
 867ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
 868{
 869	return rate->idx & 0xF;
 870}
 871
 872static inline u8
 873ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
 874{
 875	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
 876}
 877
 878/**
 879 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
 880 *
 881 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
 882 *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
 883 *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
 884 *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
 885 *
 
 
 
 886 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
 887 * @band: the band to transmit on (use for checking for races)
 888 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
 889 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
 890 * @control: union for control data
 891 * @status: union for status data
 892 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
 893 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
 894 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
 895 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
 896 * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
 897 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
 898 */
 899struct ieee80211_tx_info {
 900	/* common information */
 901	u32 flags;
 902	u8 band;
 903
 904	u8 hw_queue;
 905
 906	u16 ack_frame_id;
 
 907
 908	union {
 909		struct {
 910			union {
 911				/* rate control */
 912				struct {
 913					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
 914						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 915					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
 916					u8 use_rts:1;
 917					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
 918					u8 short_preamble:1;
 919					u8 skip_table:1;
 920					/* 2 bytes free */
 921				};
 922				/* only needed before rate control */
 923				unsigned long jiffies;
 924			};
 925			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
 926			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
 927			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
 928			u32 flags;
 929			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
 930		} control;
 931		struct {
 932			u64 cookie;
 933		} ack;
 934		struct {
 935			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 936			s32 ack_signal;
 937			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
 
 938			u8 ampdu_len;
 939			u8 antenna;
 940			u16 tx_time;
 941			bool is_valid_ack_signal;
 942			void *status_driver_data[19 / sizeof(void *)];
 943		} status;
 944		struct {
 945			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
 946				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
 947			u8 pad[4];
 948
 949			void *rate_driver_data[
 950				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
 951		};
 952		void *driver_data[
 953			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
 954	};
 955};
 956
 957/**
 958 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx staus info for rate control
 959 *
 960 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
 961 * @info: Basic tx status information
 962 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
 963 */
 964struct ieee80211_tx_status {
 965	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
 966	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
 967	struct sk_buff *skb;
 968};
 969
 970/**
 971 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
 972 *
 973 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
 974 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
 975 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
 976 *
 977 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
 978 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
 979 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
 980 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
 981 */
 982struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
 983	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 984	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
 985	const u8 *common_ies;
 986	size_t common_ie_len;
 987};
 988
 989
 990static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
 991{
 992	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
 993}
 994
 995static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
 996{
 997	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
 998}
 999
1000/**
1001 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1002 *
1003 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1004 *
1005 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1006 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1007 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1008 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1009 *
1010 * NOTE: You can only use this function if you do NOT use
1011 *	 info->driver_data! Use info->rate_driver_data
1012 *	 instead if you need only the less space that allows.
1013 */
1014static inline void
1015ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1016{
1017	int i;
1018
1019	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1020		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1021	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1022		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1023	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1024	/* clear the rate counts */
1025	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1026		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1027
1028	BUILD_BUG_ON(
1029	    offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ack_signal) != 20);
1030	memset(&info->status.ampdu_ack_len, 0,
1031	       sizeof(struct ieee80211_tx_info) -
1032	       offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len));
1033}
1034
1035
1036/**
1037 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1038 *
1039 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1040 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1041 *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1042 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1043 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1044 *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1045 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1046 *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1047 *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1048 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1049 *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1050 *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1051 *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1052 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1053 *	de-duplication by itself.
1054 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1055 *	the frame.
1056 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1057 *	the frame.
1058 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1059 *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1060 *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1061 *	merging.
1062 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1063 *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1064 *	(including FCS) was received.
1065 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1066 *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1067 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1068 *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1069 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1070 *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1071 *	each A-MPDU
1072 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1073 *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1074 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1075 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1076 *	on this subframe
1077 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1078 *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1079 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1080 *	done by the hardware
1081 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1082 *	processing it in any regular way.
1083 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1084 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1085 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1086 *	monitor interfaces.
1087 *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1088 *	them for sniffing purposes.
1089 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1090 *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1091 *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1092 *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1093 *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1094 *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1095 *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1096 *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1097 *	interleaved with other frames.
1098 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1099 *	radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1100 *	the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
1101 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1102 *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1103 *	the first subframe.
1104 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1105 *	be done in the hardware.
1106 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1107 *	frame
1108 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1109 */
1110enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1111	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1112	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1113	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1114	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1115	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1116	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1117	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1118	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1119	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1120	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1121	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1122	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1123	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1124	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1125	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1126	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1127	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1128	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1129	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1130	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1131	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA	= BIT(20),
1132	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1133	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1134	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1135	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1136	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1137};
1138
1139/**
1140 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1141 *
1142 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1143 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1144 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1145 *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1146 *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1147 *	to hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact
1148 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1149 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1150 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1151 */
1152enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1153	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1154	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1155	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1156	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1157	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1158	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1159};
1160
1161#define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1162
1163enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1164	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1165	RX_ENC_HT,
1166	RX_ENC_VHT,
1167};
1168
1169/**
1170 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1171 *
1172 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1173 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1174 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1175 *
1176 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1177 * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1178 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1179 *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1180 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1181 *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1182 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1183 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1184 *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1185 *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1186 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1187 *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1188 *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1189 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1190 *	values were filled.
1191 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1192 *	support dB or unspecified units)
1193 * @antenna: antenna used
1194 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1195 *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1196 * @nss: number of streams (VHT and HE only)
1197 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1198 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1199 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1200 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1201 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1202 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1203 *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1204 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1205 */
1206struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1207	u64 mactime;
1208	u64 boottime_ns;
1209	u32 device_timestamp;
1210	u32 ampdu_reference;
1211	u32 flag;
1212	u16 freq;
1213	u8 enc_flags;
1214	u8 encoding:2, bw:3;
1215	u8 rate_idx;
1216	u8 nss;
1217	u8 rx_flags;
1218	u8 band;
1219	u8 antenna;
1220	s8 signal;
1221	u8 chains;
1222	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1223	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1224};
1225
1226/**
1227 * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1228 * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1229 *	(this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1230 *	 bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1231 * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1232 *	alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1233 *	description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1234 *	Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1235 * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1236 * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1237 * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1238 *	then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1239 *	@data field.
1240 * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1241 *	the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1242 *	length
1243 * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1244 *
1245 * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1246 * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1247 * data.
1248 */
1249struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1250	u32 present;
1251	u8 align;
1252	u8 oui[3];
1253	u8 subns;
1254	u8 pad;
1255	u16 len;
1256	u8 data[];
1257} __packed;
1258
1259/**
1260 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1261 *
1262 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1263 *
1264 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1265 *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1266 *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1267 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1268 *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1269 *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1270 *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1271 *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1272 *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1273 *	for more.
1274 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1275 *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1276 *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1277 *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1278 *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1279 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1280 *	operating channel.
1281 */
1282enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1283	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1284	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1285	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1286	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1287};
1288
1289
1290/**
1291 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1292 *
1293 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1294 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1295 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1296 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1297 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1298 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1299 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1300 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1301 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1302 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1303 */
1304enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1305	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1306	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1307	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1308	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1309	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1310	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1311	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1312	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1313};
1314
1315/**
1316 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1317 *
1318 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1319 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1320 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1321 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1322 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1323 */
1324enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1325	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1326	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1327	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1328	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1329
1330	/* keep last */
1331	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1332};
1333
1334/**
1335 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1336 *
1337 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1338 *
1339 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1340 *
1341 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
 
 
 
 
 
1342 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1343 *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1344 *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1345 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1346 *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1347 *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1348 *
1349 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1350 *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1351 *
1352 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1353 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1354 *
1355 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1356 *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1357 *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1358 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1359 *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1360 *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1361 *
1362 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1363 *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1364 *	configured for an HT channel.
1365 *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1366 *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1367 */
1368struct ieee80211_conf {
1369	u32 flags;
1370	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
 
1371
1372	u16 listen_interval;
1373	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1374
1375	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1376
1377	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1378	bool radar_enabled;
1379	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1380};
1381
1382/**
1383 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1384 *
1385 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1386 * operation.
1387 *
1388 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1389 *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1390 *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1391 *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1392 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1393 *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1394 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1395 *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1396 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1397 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1398 */
1399struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1400	u64 timestamp;
1401	u32 device_timestamp;
1402	bool block_tx;
1403	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1404	u8 count;
1405};
1406
1407/**
1408 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1409 *
1410 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1411 *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1412 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1413 *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1414 *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1415 *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1416 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1417 *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1418 *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1419 *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1420 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1421 *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1422 *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1423 */
1424enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1425	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1426	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1427	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1428	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1429};
1430
1431/**
1432 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1433 *
1434 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1435 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1436 *
1437 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1438 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1439 *	or the BSS we're associated to
1440 * @addr: address of this interface
1441 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1442 *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1443 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
1444 *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
1445 *	for read access.
1446 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
1447 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1448 *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1449 *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1450 *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1451 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1452 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1453 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
1454 *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
1455 *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
1456 *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
1457 *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
1458 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1459 *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1460 *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1461 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1462 *	interface.
1463 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1464 *	sizeof(void \*).
1465 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction)
1466 */
1467struct ieee80211_vif {
1468	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1469	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1470	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1471	bool p2p;
1472	bool csa_active;
1473	bool mu_mimo_owner;
1474
1475	u8 cab_queue;
1476	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1477
1478	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1479
1480	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
1481
1482	u32 driver_flags;
1483
1484#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1485	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1486#endif
1487
1488	unsigned int probe_req_reg;
1489
1490	/* must be last */
1491	u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1492};
1493
1494static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1495{
1496#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1497	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1498#endif
1499	return false;
1500}
1501
1502/**
1503 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1504 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1505 *
1506 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1507 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1508 *
1509 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1510 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1511 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1512 */
1513struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1514
1515/**
1516 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1517 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1518 *
1519 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1520 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1521 *
1522 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1523 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1524 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1525 */
1526struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1527
1528/**
1529 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1530 *
1531 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1532 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1533 *
 
 
1534 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1535 *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1536 *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1537 *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1538 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1539 *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1540 *	generation in software.
1541 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1542 *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1543 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1544 *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1545 *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1546 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1547 *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1548 *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1549 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1550 *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1551 *	MIC.
1552 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1553 *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1554 *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1555 *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1556 *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1557 *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1558 *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1559 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1560 *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1561 *	only for managment frames (MFP).
1562 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1563 *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1564 *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
1565 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
1566 *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
1567 *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
1568 */
1569enum ieee80211_key_flags {
1570	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
1571	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
1572	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
1573	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
1574	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
1575	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
1576	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
1577	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
1578	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
1579};
1580
1581/**
1582 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
1583 *
1584 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
1585 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
1586 *
1587 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
1588 *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
1589 *	encrypted in hardware.
1590 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
1591 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
1592 *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
1593 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
1594 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
1595 * @keylen: key material length
1596 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
1597 * 	data block:
1598 * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
1599 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
1600 * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
1601 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
1602 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
1603 */
1604struct ieee80211_key_conf {
1605	atomic64_t tx_pn;
1606	u32 cipher;
1607	u8 icv_len;
1608	u8 iv_len;
1609	u8 hw_key_idx;
 
1610	s8 keyidx;
1611	u16 flags;
1612	u8 keylen;
1613	u8 key[0];
1614};
1615
1616#define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
1617
1618#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
1619#define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
1620
1621/**
1622 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
1623 *
1624 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
1625 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1626 *	reverse order than in packet)
1627 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1628 *	reverse order than in packet)
1629 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1630 *	reverse order than in packet)
1631 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1632 *	reverse order than in packet)
1633 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
1634 */
1635struct ieee80211_key_seq {
1636	union {
1637		struct {
1638			u32 iv32;
1639			u16 iv16;
1640		} tkip;
1641		struct {
1642			u8 pn[6];
1643		} ccmp;
1644		struct {
1645			u8 pn[6];
1646		} aes_cmac;
1647		struct {
1648			u8 pn[6];
1649		} aes_gmac;
1650		struct {
1651			u8 pn[6];
1652		} gcmp;
1653		struct {
1654			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
1655			u8 seq_len;
1656		} hw;
1657	};
1658};
1659
1660/**
1661 * struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme - cipher scheme
1662 *
1663 * This structure contains a cipher scheme information defining
1664 * the secure packet crypto handling.
1665 *
1666 * @cipher: a cipher suite selector
1667 * @iftype: a cipher iftype bit mask indicating an allowed cipher usage
1668 * @hdr_len: a length of a security header used the cipher
1669 * @pn_len: a length of a packet number in the security header
1670 * @pn_off: an offset of pn from the beginning of the security header
1671 * @key_idx_off: an offset of key index byte in the security header
1672 * @key_idx_mask: a bit mask of key_idx bits
1673 * @key_idx_shift: a bit shift needed to get key_idx
1674 *     key_idx value calculation:
1675 *      (sec_header_base[key_idx_off] & key_idx_mask) >> key_idx_shift
1676 * @mic_len: a mic length in bytes
1677 */
1678struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme {
1679	u32 cipher;
1680	u16 iftype;
1681	u8 hdr_len;
1682	u8 pn_len;
1683	u8 pn_off;
1684	u8 key_idx_off;
1685	u8 key_idx_mask;
1686	u8 key_idx_shift;
1687	u8 mic_len;
1688};
1689
1690/**
1691 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
1692 *
1693 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
1694 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
1695 *
1696 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
1697 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
1698 */
1699enum set_key_cmd {
1700	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
1701};
1702
1703/**
1704 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
1705 *
1706 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
1707 *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
1708 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
1709 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
1710 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
1711 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
1712 */
1713enum ieee80211_sta_state {
1714	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
1715	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
1716	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
1717	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
1718	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
1719	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
1720};
1721
1722/**
1723 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
1724 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
1725 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
1726 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
1727 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
1728 *	(including 80+80 MHz)
1729 *
1730 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
1731 *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
1732 */
1733enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
1734	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
1735	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
1736	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
1737	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
1738};
1739
1740/**
1741 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
1742 *
1743 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
1744 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
1745 *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
1746 */
1747struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
1748	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
1749	struct {
1750		s8 idx;
1751		u8 count;
1752		u8 count_cts;
1753		u8 count_rts;
1754		u16 flags;
1755	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
1756};
1757
1758/**
1759 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
1760 *
1761 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
1762 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
1763 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
1764 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
1765 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
1766 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
1767 *
1768 * @addr: MAC address
1769 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
1770 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates (per band)
1771 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
1772 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
1773 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
1774 *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
1775 *	Can be modified by driver.
1776 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
1777 *	otherwise always false)
1778 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1779 *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
1780 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
1781 *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
1782 *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
1783 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
1784 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
1785 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
1786 *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
1787 *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
1788 *	the station moves to associated state.
1789 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
1790 * @rates: rate control selection table
1791 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
1792 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
1793 *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
1794 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
1795 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
1796 *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
1797 *	unlimited.
1798 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
1799 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
1800 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction)
1801 */
1802struct ieee80211_sta {
1803	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1804	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1805	u16 aid;
1806	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
1807	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
1808	u8 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
1809	bool wme;
1810	u8 uapsd_queues;
1811	u8 max_sp;
1812	u8 rx_nss;
1813	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
1814	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1815	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
1816	bool tdls;
1817	bool tdls_initiator;
1818	bool mfp;
1819	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
1820
1821	/**
1822	 * @max_amsdu_len:
1823	 * indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
1824	 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
1825	 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
1826	 *
1827	 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
1828	 *   A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
1829	 * * If the skb is not part of a BA aggreement, the A-MSDU maximal
1830	 *   size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
1831	 *
1832	 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
1833	 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
1834	 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
1835	 */
1836	u16 max_amsdu_len;
1837	bool support_p2p_ps;
1838	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
1839
1840	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
1841
1842	/* must be last */
1843	u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1844};
1845
1846/**
1847 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
1848 *
1849 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
1850 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
1851 *
1852 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
1853 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
1854 */
1855enum sta_notify_cmd {
1856	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
1857};
1858
1859/**
1860 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
1861 *
1862 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
1863 * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
1864 */
1865struct ieee80211_tx_control {
1866	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1867};
1868
1869/**
1870 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
1871 *
1872 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
1873 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
1874 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue)
1875 * @ac: the AC for this queue
1876 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
1877 *
1878 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
1879 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
1880 */
1881struct ieee80211_txq {
1882	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1883	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1884	u8 tid;
1885	u8 ac;
1886
1887	/* must be last */
1888	u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1889};
1890
1891/**
1892 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
1893 *
1894 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
1895 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
1896 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
1897 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
1898 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
1899 *
1900 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
1901 *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
1902 *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
1903 *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
1904 *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
1905 *	algorithm.
1906 *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
1907 *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
1908 *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
1909 *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
1910 *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
1911 *	CCK frames.
1912 *
1913 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
1914 *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
1915 *	the FCS at the end.
1916 *
1917 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
1918 *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
1919 *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
1920 *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
1921 *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
1922 *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
1923 *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
1924 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1925 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
1926 *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
1927 *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
1928 *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
1929 *
1930 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
1931 *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
1932 *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
1933 *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
1934 *
1935 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
1936 * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
1937 * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
1938 *
1939 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
1940 *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
1941 *
1942 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
1943 *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
1944 *
1945 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
1946 *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
1947 *	stack support for dynamic PS.
1948 *
1949 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
1950 *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
1951 *
1952 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
1953 *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
1954 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1955 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
1956 *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
1957 *	the stack.
1958 *
1959 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
1960 *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
1961 *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1962 *
1963 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
1964 *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
1965 *	dtim_period).
1966 *
1967 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
1968 *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
1969 *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
1970 *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
1971 *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
1972 *	only in that case.
1973 *
1974 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
1975 *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
1976 *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
1977 *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
1978 *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
1979 *	the PS mode of connected stations.
1980 *
1981 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
1982 *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
1983 *	software.
1984 *
1985 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
1986 *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
1987 *	active interfaces.
1988 *
1989 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
1990 *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
1991 *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
1992 *
1993 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
1994 *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
1995 *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
1996 *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
1997 *	supported cipher suites.
1998 *
1999 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2000 *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2001 *	for frames.
2002 *
2003 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2004 *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2005 *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2006 *	control for more details.
2007 *
2008 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2009 *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2010 *
2011 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2012 *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2013 *	is supported.
2014 *
2015 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2016 *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2017 *
2018 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2019 *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2020 *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2021 *
2022 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2023 *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2024 *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2025 *	CSA frame.
2026 *
2027 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2028 *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2029 *
2030 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2031 *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2032 *
2033 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2034 *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2035 *
2036 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2037 *	within A-MPDU.
2038 *
2039 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2040 *	for sent beacons.
2041 *
2042 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2043 *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2044 *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2045 *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2046 *
2047 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2048 *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2049 *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2050 *	timeout.
2051 *
2052 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2053 *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2054 *
2055 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2056 *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2057 *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2058 *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2059 *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2060 *
2061 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2062 *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2063 *
2064 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2065 *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2066 *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2067 *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2068 *
2069 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2070 *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2071 *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2072 *
2073 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2074 *	TDLS links.
2075 *
2076 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2077 *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2078 *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2079 *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2080 *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2081 *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2082 *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2083 *
2084 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2085 *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2086 *
2087 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2088 */
2089enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2090	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2091	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2092	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2093	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2094	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2095	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2096	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2097	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2098	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2099	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2100	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2101	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2102	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2103	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2104	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2105	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2106	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2107	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2108	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2109	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2110	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2111	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2112	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2113	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2114	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2115	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2116	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2117	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2118	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2119	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2120	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2121	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2122	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2123	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2124	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2125	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2126	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2127	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2128	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2129	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2130	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2131	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2132
2133	/* keep last, obviously */
2134	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2135};
2136
2137/**
2138 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2139 *
2140 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2141 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2142 *
2143 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2144 *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2145 *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2146 *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2147 *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2148 *
2149 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2150 *
2151 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2152 *	along with this structure.
2153 *
2154 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2155 *
2156 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2157 *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2158 *
2159 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2160 *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2161 *
2162 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2163 *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2164 *
2165 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2166 *	that HW supports
2167 *
2168 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2169 *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2170 *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2171 *
2172 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2173 *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2174 *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2175 *
2176 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2177 *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2178 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2179 *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2180 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2181 *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2182 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2183 *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2184 *
2185 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2186 *	can handle.
2187 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2188 *	the hw can report back.
2189 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2190 *
 
 
 
 
2191 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2192 *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2193 *	aggregation.
2194 *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2195 *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2196 *	it shouldn't be set.
2197 *
2198 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2199 *	aggregate an HT driver will transmit. Though ADDBA will advertise
2200 *	a constant value of 64 as some older APs can crash if the window
2201 *	size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N with FW v1.0.07
2202 *	build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2203 *
2204 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2205 *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2206 *
2207 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2208 *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2209 *
2210 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2211 *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2212 *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2213 *	adding _BW is supported today.
2214 *
2215 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2216 *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2217 *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2218 *
2219 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2220 *	'units_pos' member is set to a non-negative value it must be set to
2221 *	a combination of a IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2222 *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value, and then the timestamp
2223 *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2224 *	device_timestamp. If the 'accuracy' member is non-negative, it's put
2225 *	into the accuracy radiotap field and the accuracy known flag is set.
2226 *
2227 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2228 *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2229 *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2230 *
2231 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2232 *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2233 *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2234 *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2235 *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2236 *	neither enabled.
2237 *
2238 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2239 *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2240 *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2241 *
2242 * @n_cipher_schemes: a size of an array of cipher schemes definitions.
2243 * @cipher_schemes: a pointer to an array of cipher scheme definitions
2244 *	supported by HW.
2245 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2246 *	device.
2247 */
2248struct ieee80211_hw {
2249	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2250	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2251	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2252	void *priv;
2253	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2254	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2255	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2256	int vif_data_size;
2257	int sta_data_size;
2258	int chanctx_data_size;
2259	int txq_data_size;
2260	u16 queues;
2261	u16 max_listen_interval;
2262	s8 max_signal;
2263	u8 max_rates;
2264	u8 max_report_rates;
2265	u8 max_rate_tries;
2266	u8 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2267	u8 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2268	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2269	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2270	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2271	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2272	struct {
2273		int units_pos;
2274		s16 accuracy;
2275	} radiotap_timestamp;
2276	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2277	u8 uapsd_queues;
2278	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2279	u8 n_cipher_schemes;
2280	const struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme *cipher_schemes;
2281	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2282};
2283
2284static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2285				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2286{
2287	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2288}
2289#define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2290
2291static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2292				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2293{
2294	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2295}
2296#define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2297
2298/**
2299 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2300 *
2301 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2302 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2303 */
2304struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2305	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2306
2307	/* Keep last */
2308	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2309};
2310
2311/**
2312 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2313 *
2314 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2315 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2316 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2317 * @status: channel-switch response status
2318 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2319 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2320 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2321 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2322 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2323 */
2324struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2325	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2326	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2327	u8 action_code;
2328	u32 status;
2329	u32 timestamp;
2330	u16 switch_time;
2331	u16 switch_timeout;
2332	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2333	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2334};
2335
2336/**
2337 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2338 *
2339 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2340 *
2341 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2342 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2343 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2344 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2345 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2346 *
2347 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2348 */
2349struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2350
2351/**
2352 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2353 *
2354 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2355 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2356 */
2357static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2358{
2359	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2360}
2361
2362/**
2363 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2364 *
2365 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2366 * @addr: the address to set
2367 */
2368static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2369{
2370	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2371}
2372
2373static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2374ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2375		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2376{
2377	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2378		return NULL;
2379	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2380}
2381
2382static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2383ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2384			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2385{
2386	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2387		return NULL;
2388	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2389}
2390
2391static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2392ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2393			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2394{
2395	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2396		return NULL;
2397	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2398}
2399
2400/**
2401 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
2402 * @hw: the hardware
2403 * @skb: the skb
2404 *
2405 * Free a transmit skb. Use this funtion when some failure
2406 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
2407 */
2408void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2409
2410/**
2411 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
2412 *
2413 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
2414 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
2415 *
2416 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
2417 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
2418 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
2419 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
2420 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
2421 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
2422 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
2423 *
2424 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
2425 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
2426 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
2427 *
2428 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
2429 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
2430 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
2431 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
2432 *
2433 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
2434 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
2435 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
2436 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
2437 *
2438 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
2439 *
2440 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
2441 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
2442 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
2443 * based on the receive flags.
2444 *
2445 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
2446 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
2447 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
2448 * keys.
2449 *
2450 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
2451 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
2452 * handler.
2453 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
2454 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
2455 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
2456 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
2457 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
2458 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
2459 *
2460 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
2461 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
2462 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
2463 */
2464
2465/**
2466 * DOC: Powersave support
2467 *
2468 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
2469 *
2470 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
2471 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
2472 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
2473 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
2474 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
2475 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
2476 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
2477 * it finds traffic directed to it.
2478 *
2479 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
2480 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
2481 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
2482 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
2483 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
2484 *
2485 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
2486 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
2487 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
2488 *
2489 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
2490 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
2491 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
2492 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
2493 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
2494 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
2495 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
2496 *
2497 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
2498 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
2499 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
2500 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
2501 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
2502 * periods.
2503 *
2504 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
2505 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
2506 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
2507 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
2508 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
2509 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
2510 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
2511 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
2512 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
2513 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
2514 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2515 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
2516 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
2517 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
2518 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
2519 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
2520 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
2521 *
2522 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
2523 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
2524 */
2525
2526/**
2527 * DOC: Beacon filter support
2528 *
2529 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
2530 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
2531 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
2532 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
2533 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
2534 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
2535 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
2536 *
2537 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
2538 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
2539 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
2540 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
2541 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
2542 *
2543 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
2544 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
2545 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
2546 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
2547 *
2548 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
2549 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
2550 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
2551 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
2552 *
2553 *  - a list of information element IDs
2554 *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
2555 *
2556 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
2557 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
2558 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
2559 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
2560 * vendor information elements.
2561 *
2562 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
2563 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
2564 *
2565 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
2566 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
2567 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
2568 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
2569 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
2570 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
2571 *
2572 *
2573 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
2574 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
2575 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
2576 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
2577 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
2578 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
2579 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
2580 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
2581 *
2582 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
2583 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
2584 * signal strength threshold checking.
2585 */
2586
2587/**
2588 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
2589 *
2590 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
2591 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
2592 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
2593 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
2594 *
2595 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
2596 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
2597 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
2598 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
2599 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
2600 * hardware flags.
2601 *
2602 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
2603 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
2604 * turned off otherwise.
2605 *
2606 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
2607 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
2608 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
2609 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
2610 */
2611
2612/**
2613 * DOC: Frame filtering
2614 *
2615 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
2616 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
2617 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
2618 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
2619 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
2620 *
2621 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
2622 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
2623 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
2624 *
2625 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
2626 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
2627 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
2628 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
2629 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
2630 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
2631 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
2632 *
2633 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
2634 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
2635 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
2636 * or dropped.
2637 *
2638 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
2639 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
2640 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
2641 * the flag, but not clear it.
2642 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
2643 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
2644 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
2645 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
2646 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
2647 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
2648 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
2649 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
2650 */
2651
2652/**
2653 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
2654 *
2655 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
2656 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
2657 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
2658 *
2659 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
2660 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
2661 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
2662 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
2663 * the driver code.
2664 *
2665 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
2666 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
2667 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
2668 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
2669 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
2670 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
2671 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
2672 *
2673 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
2674 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
2675 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
2676 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
2677 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
2678 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
2679 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
2680 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
2681 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
2682 * @sta_notify callback.
2683 *
2684 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
2685 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
2686 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
2687 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
2688 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
2689 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
2690 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
2691 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
2692 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
2693 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
2694 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
2695 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
2696 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
2697 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
2698 *
2699 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
2700 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
2701 *
2702 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
2703 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
2704 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
2705 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
2706 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
2707 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
2708 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
2709 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
2710 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
2711 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
2712 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
2713 *
2714 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
2715 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
2716 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
2717 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
2718 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
2719 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
2720 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
2721 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
2722 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
2723 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
2724 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
2725 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
2726 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
2727 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
2728 *
2729 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
2730 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
2731 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
2732 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
2733 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
2734 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
2735 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
2736 *
2737 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
2738 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
2739 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
2740 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
2741 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
2742 *
2743 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
2744 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
2745 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
2746 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
2747 */
2748
2749/**
2750 * DOC: HW queue control
2751 *
2752 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
2753 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
2754 * was problematic for a few reasons:
2755 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
2756 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
2757 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
2758 *
2759 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
2760 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
2761 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
2762 *
2763 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
2764 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
2765 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
2766 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
2767 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
2768 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
2769 * the hardware queue.
2770 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
2771 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
2772 *
2773 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
2774 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
2775 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
2776 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
2777 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
2778 *
2779 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
2780 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
2781 * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
2782 * off-channel queue:         9
2783 *
2784 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
2785 *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
2786 *
2787 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
2788 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
2789 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
2790 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
2791 *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
2792 *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
2793 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
2794 *
2795 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
2796 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
2797 *
2798 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
2799 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
2800 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
2801 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
2802 */
2803
2804/**
2805 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
2806 *
2807 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
2808 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
2809 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
2810 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
2811 *
 
 
 
 
2812 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
2813 *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
2814 *	multicast address.
2815 *
2816 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
2817 *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
2818 *
2819 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
2820 *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
2821 *
2822 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
2823 *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
2824 *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
2825 *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
2826 *	honour this flag if possible.
2827 *
2828 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
2829 *	station
2830 *
2831 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
2832 *
2833 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
 
2834 *
2835 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
2836 */
2837enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
 
2838	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
2839	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
2840	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
2841	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
2842	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
2843	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
2844	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
2845	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
2846};
2847
2848/**
2849 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
2850 *
2851 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
2852 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
2853 *
2854 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
2855 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
2856 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
2857 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
2858 *
2859 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
2860 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
2861 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation
 
2862 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
2863 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
2864 *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
2865 *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
2866 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
2867 *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
2868 *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
2869 *	session is gone and removes the station.
2870 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
2871 *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
2872 *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
2873 *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
2874 */
2875enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
2876	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
2877	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
2878	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
2879	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
2880	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
2881	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
2882	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
2883};
2884
2885/**
2886 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
2887 *
2888 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
2889 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
2890 * @tid: tid of the BA session
2891 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
2892 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
2893 *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
2894 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
2895 *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
2896 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
2897 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
2898 *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
2899 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
2900 *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
2901 */
2902struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
2903	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
2904	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2905	u16 tid;
2906	u16 ssn;
2907	u8 buf_size;
2908	bool amsdu;
2909	u16 timeout;
2910};
2911
2912/**
2913 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
2914 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
2915 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
2916 *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
2917 */
2918enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
2919	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
2920	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
2921};
2922
2923/**
2924 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
2925 *
2926 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
2927 *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
2928 *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
2929 *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
2930 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
2931 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
2932 *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
2933 *	the peer.
2934 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
2935 *	by the peer
2936 */
2937enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
2938	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
2939	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
2940	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
2941	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
2942};
2943
2944/**
2945 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
2946 *
2947 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
2948 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
2949 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vise versa).
2950 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
2951 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
2952 *
2953 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
2954 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
2955 *	for sending managment frames offchannel.
2956 */
2957enum ieee80211_roc_type {
2958	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
2959	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
2960};
2961
2962/**
2963 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_complete_type - reconfig type
2964 *
2965 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
2966 * reconfiguration type was completed.
2967 *
2968 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
2969 *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
2970 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
2971 *	of wowlan configuration)
2972 */
2973enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
2974	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
2975	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
2976};
2977
2978/**
2979 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
2980 *
2981 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
2982 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
2983 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
2984 *
2985 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
2986 *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
2987 *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
2988 *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
2989 *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
2990 *	Must be atomic.
 
 
 
2991 *
2992 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
2993 *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
2994 *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
2995 *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
2996 *	or zero.
2997 *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
2998 *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
2999 *	is added.
3000 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3001 *
3002 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3003 *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3004 *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3005 *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3006 *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3007 *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3008 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3009 *
3010 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3011 *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3012 *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3013 *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3014 *	reconfigured at resume time.
3015 *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3016 *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3017 *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3018 *	must return 1 from this function.
3019 *
3020 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3021 *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3022 *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3023 *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3024 *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3025 *
3026 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3027 *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3028 *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3029 *	in suspend().
3030 *
3031 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3032 *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3033 *	and @stop must be implemented.
3034 *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3035 *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3036 *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3037 *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3038 *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3039 *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3040 *
3041 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3042 *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3043 *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3044 *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3045 *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3046 *
3047 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3048 *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3049 *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3050 *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3051 *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3052 *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3053 *	MAC address of the device going away.
3054 *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3055 *
3056 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3057 *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3058 *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3059 *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3060 *
3061 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3062 *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3063 *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3064 *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3065 *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3066 *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3067 *	can sleep.
3068 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3069 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3070 *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3071 *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3072 *
3073 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3074 *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3075 *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3076 *
3077 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3078 *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3079 *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3080 *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3081 *	which flags are changed.
3082 *	This callback can sleep.
3083 *
3084 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3085 * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3086 *
3087 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3088 *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3089 *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3090 *	is enabled.
3091 *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3092 *	The callback can sleep.
3093 *
3094 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3095 * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3096 * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3097 *	The callback must be atomic.
3098 *
3099 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3100 *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3101 *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3102 *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3103 *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3104 *
3105 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3106 *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3107 *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3108 *
3109 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3110 *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3111 *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3112 *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3113 *	that power save is disabled.
3114 *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3115 *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3116 *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3117 *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3118 *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3119 *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3120 *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3121 *	The callback can sleep.
3122 *
3123 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3124 *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3125 *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3126 *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3127 *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3128 *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3129 *	The callback can sleep.
3130 *
3131 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3132 *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3133 *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3134 *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3135 *
3136 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3137 *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3138 *
3139 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3140 *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3141 *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3142 *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3143 *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3144 *
3145 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3146 *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3147 *	this notification.
3148 *	The callback can sleep.
3149 *
3150 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3151 * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3152 *	The callback can sleep.
3153 *
3154 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3155 *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3156 *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3157 *	The callback must be atomic.
3158 *
3159 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3160 *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3161 *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3162 *	should be set as well.
3163 *	The callback can sleep.
3164 *
3165 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3166 *	The callback can sleep.
3167 *
3168 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3169 *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3170 *
3171 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3172 *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3173 *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3174 *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3175 *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3176 *	This callback can sleep.
3177 *
3178 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3179 *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3180 *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3181 *	callback can sleep.
3182 *
3183 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3184 *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3185 *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3186 *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3187 *
3188 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3189 *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3190 *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3191 *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3192 *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3193 *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3194 *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3195 *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3196 *	The callback can sleep.
3197 *
3198 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3199 *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3200 *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3201 *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3202 *	in @sta_state.
3203 *	The callback can sleep.
3204 *
3205 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3206 *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3207 *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3208 *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3209 *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3210 *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3211 *	Must be atomic.
3212 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3213 *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3214 *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3215 *
3216 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3217 *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3218 *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3219 *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3220 *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3221 *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3222 *	The callback can sleep.
3223 *
3224 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3225 *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3226 *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3227 *	The callback can sleep.
3228 *
3229 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3230 *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3231 *	required function.
3232 *	The callback can sleep.
3233 *
3234 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3235 *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3236 *	required function.
3237 *	The callback can sleep.
3238 *
3239 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3240 *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3241 *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3242 *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3243 *	The callback can sleep.
3244 *
3245 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3246 *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3247 *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3248 *	TSF synchronization.
3249 *	The callback can sleep.
3250 *
3251 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3252 *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3253 *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3254 *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3255 *	The callback can sleep.
3256 *
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
3257 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3258 *
3259 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3260 *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3261 *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3262 *	The callback can sleep.
3263 *
3264 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3265 *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3266 *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3267 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3268 *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3269 *
3270 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3271 *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3272 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3273 *
3274 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3275 *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3276 *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3277 *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3278 *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3279 *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3280 *	The callback can sleep.
3281 *
3282 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3283 *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3284 *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3285 *	completion of the channel switch.
3286 *
 
 
3287 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3288 *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3289 *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3290 *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3291 *
3292 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3293 *
3294 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3295 *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3296 *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3297 *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3298 *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3299 *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3300 *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3301 *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3302 *	must be accepted in this case.
3303 *	This callback may sleep.
3304 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3305 *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
 
 
 
 
 
3306 *
3307 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3308 *
3309 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3310 *
3311 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3312 *	queues before entering power save.
3313 *
3314 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3315 *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3316 *	The callback can sleep.
3317 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3318 *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3319 *	The callback must be atomic.
3320 *
3321 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3322 *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3323 *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3324 *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3325 *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3326 *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3327 *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3328 *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
3329 *	more-data bit must always be set.
3330 *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
3331 *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
3332 *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
3333 *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
3334 *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3335 *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
3336 *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
3337 *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
3338 *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
3339 *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
3340 *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
3341 *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
3342 *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
3343 *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
3344 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
3345 *	This callback must be atomic.
3346 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
3347 *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
3348 *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
3349 *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
3350 *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
3351 *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
3352 *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3353 *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
3354 *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
3355 *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
3356 *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
3357 *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
3358 *	This callback must be atomic.
3359 *
3360 * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
3361 *
3362 * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
3363 *
3364 * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
3365 *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
3366 *
3367 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
3368 *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
3369 *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
3370 *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
3371 *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
3372 *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
3373 *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
3374 *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
3375 *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
3376 *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
3377 *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
3378 *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
3379 *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
3380 *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
3381 *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
3382 *
3383 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
3384 *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
3385 *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
3386 *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
3387 *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
3388 *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
3389 *	2 * (DTIM period).
3390 *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
3391 *
3392 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
3393 *	This callback may sleep.
3394 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
3395 *	This callback may sleep.
3396 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
3397 *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
3398 *	channel context with different settings
3399 *	This callback may sleep.
3400 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
3401 *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
3402 *	This callback may sleep.
3403 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
3404 *	unbound from vif.
3405 *	This callback may sleep.
3406 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
3407 *	another, as specified in the list of
3408 *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
3409 *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
3410 *	This callback may sleep.
3411 *
3412 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
3413 *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
3414 *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
3415 *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
3416 *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
3417 *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
3418 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
3419 *
3420 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
3421 *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
3422 *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
3423 *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
3424 *	This callback may sleep.
3425 *
3426 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
3427 *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
3428 *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
3429 *
3430 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
3431 *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
3432 *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
3433 *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
3434 *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
3435 *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
3436 *	1 using ieee80211_csa_is_complete() after the beacon has been
3437 *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
3438 *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
3439 *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
3440 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3441 *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
3442 *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
3443 *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
3444 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3445 *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
3446 *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3447 *
3448 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
3449 *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
3450 *	channel context is bound before this is called.
3451 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
3452 *
3453 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
3454 *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
3455 *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
3456 *
3457 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
3458 *	and hardware limits.
3459 *
3460 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3461 *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3462 *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
3463 *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
3464 *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
3465 *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
3466 *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
3467 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3468 *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3469 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
3470 *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
3471 *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
3472 *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
3473 *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
3474 *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
3475 *	the function call.
3476 *
3477 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
3478 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
3479 *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
3480 *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
3481 *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
3482 *
3483 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
3484 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
3485 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
3486 *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
3487 *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
3488 *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
3489 *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
3490 *	changed parameters.
3491 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
3492 *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
3493 *	this call.
3494 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
3495 *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
3496 *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
3497 */
3498struct ieee80211_ops {
3499	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3500		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
3501		   struct sk_buff *skb);
3502	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3503	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3504#ifdef CONFIG_PM
3505	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
3506	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3507	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
3508#endif
3509	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3510			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3511	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3512				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3513				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
3514	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3515				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3516	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
3517	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3518				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3519				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
3520				 u32 changed);
3521
3522	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3523	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
 
 
 
 
3524
3525	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3526				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
3527	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3528				 unsigned int changed_flags,
3529				 unsigned int *total_flags,
3530				 u64 multicast);
3531	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3532				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3533				    unsigned int filter_flags,
3534				    unsigned int changed_flags);
3535	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3536		       bool set);
3537	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
3538		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3539		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
3540	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3541				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3542				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
3543				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3544				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
3545	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3546			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3547			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
3548	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3549					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
3550	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3551		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
3552	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3553			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3554	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3555				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3556				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
3557				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
3558	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3559			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3560	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3561			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3562			      const u8 *mac_addr);
3563	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3564				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3565	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3566			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
3567	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3568			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
3569			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
3570	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3571	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3572	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3573		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3574	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3575			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3576#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
3577	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3578				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3579				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3580				struct dentry *dir);
3581#endif
3582	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3583			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3584	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3585			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3586			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
3587			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
3588	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3589				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3590				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3591	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3592			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3593			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3594			      u32 changed);
3595	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3596				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3597				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3598	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3599			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3600			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3601			       struct station_info *sinfo);
3602	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3603		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ac,
3604		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
3605	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3606	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3607			u64 tsf);
3608	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3609			   s64 offset);
3610	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3611	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3612
3613	/**
3614	 * @ampdu_action:
3615	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
3616	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
3617	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
3618	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3619	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
3620	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
3621	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
3622	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
3623	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
3624	 *
3625	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
3626	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
3627	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
3628	 *
3629	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
3630	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
3631	 *
3632	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
3633	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
3634	 * - ``TX:        81``
3635	 *
3636	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
3637	 *
3638	 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
3639	 * The callback can sleep.
3640	 */
3641	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3642			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3643			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
 
 
3644	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
3645		struct survey_info *survey);
3646	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3647	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
3648#ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
3649	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3650			    void *data, int len);
3651	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
3652			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
3653			     void *data, int len);
3654#endif
3655	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3656		      u32 queues, bool drop);
3657	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3658			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3659			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
 
3660	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
3661	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
3662
3663	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3664				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3665				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
3666				 int duration,
3667				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
3668	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
 
 
 
 
 
3669	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
3670	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3671			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
3672	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3673	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3674				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
3675	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3676			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3677			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
3678
3679	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3680				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3681				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
3682				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
3683				      bool more_data);
3684	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3685					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3686					u16 tids, int num_frames,
3687					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
3688					bool more_data);
3689
3690	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3691				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
3692	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3693				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3694				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
3695	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3696				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3697				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
3698
3699	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3700				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3701
3702	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3703					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3704
3705	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3706			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3707	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3708			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3709	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3710			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
3711			       u32 changed);
3712	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3713				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3714				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3715	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3716				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3717				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3718	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3719				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
3720				  int n_vifs,
3721				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
3722
3723	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3724				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
3725
3726#if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
3727	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3728				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3729				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
3730#endif
3731	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3732				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3733				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
3734	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3735				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3736				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
3737
3738	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3739				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3740
3741	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3742	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3743	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3744				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3745	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3746			   int *dbm);
3747
3748	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3749				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3750				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
3751				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
3752				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
3753	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3754					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3755					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3756	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3757					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3758					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
3759
3760	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3761			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
3762	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3763
3764	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3765			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3766			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
3767	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3768			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3769	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3770			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3771			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
3772	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3773			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3774			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
3775	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3776			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3777			    u8 instance_id);
3778};
3779
3780/**
3781 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
3782 *
3783 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
3784 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
3785 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
3786 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
3787 * @priv_data_len.
3788 *
3789 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
3790 * @ops: callbacks for this device
3791 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
3792 *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
3793 *
3794 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
3795 */
3796struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
3797					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
3798					   const char *requested_name);
3799
3800/**
3801 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
3802 *
3803 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
3804 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
3805 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
3806 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
3807 * @priv_data_len.
3808 *
3809 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
3810 * @ops: callbacks for this device
3811 *
3812 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
3813 */
3814static inline
3815struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
3816					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
3817{
3818	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
3819}
3820
3821/**
3822 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
3823 *
3824 * You must call this function before any other functions in
3825 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
3826 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
3827 *
3828 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
3829 *
3830 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
3831 */
3832int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3833
3834/**
3835 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
3836 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
3837 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
3838 *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
3839 */
3840struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
3841	int throughput;
3842	int blink_time;
3843};
3844
3845/**
3846 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
3847 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
3848 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
3849 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
3850 *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
3851 */
3852enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
3853	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
3854	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
3855	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
3856};
3857
3858#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3859const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3860const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3861const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3862const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3863const char *
3864__ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3865				   unsigned int flags,
3866				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
3867				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
3868#endif
3869/**
3870 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
3871 *
3872 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
3873 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
3874 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
3875 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
3876 *
3877 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
3878 *
3879 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
3880 */
3881static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
3882{
3883#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3884	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
3885#else
3886	return NULL;
3887#endif
3888}
3889
3890/**
3891 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
3892 *
3893 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
3894 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
3895 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
3896 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
3897 *
3898 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
3899 *
3900 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
3901 */
3902static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
3903{
3904#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3905	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
3906#else
3907	return NULL;
3908#endif
3909}
3910
3911/**
3912 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
3913 *
3914 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
3915 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
3916 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
3917 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
3918 *
3919 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
3920 *
3921 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
3922 */
3923static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
3924{
3925#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3926	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
3927#else
3928	return NULL;
3929#endif
3930}
3931
3932/**
3933 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
3934 *
3935 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
3936 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
3937 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
3938 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
3939 *
3940 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
3941 *
3942 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
3943 */
3944static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
3945{
3946#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3947	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
3948#else
3949	return NULL;
3950#endif
3951}
3952
3953/**
3954 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
3955 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
3956 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
3957 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
3958 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
3959 *
3960 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
3961 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
3962 *
3963 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
3964 */
3965static inline const char *
3966ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
3967				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
3968				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
3969{
3970#ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
3971	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
3972						  blink_table_len);
3973#else
3974	return NULL;
3975#endif
3976}
3977
3978/**
3979 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
3980 *
3981 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
3982 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
3983 *
3984 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
3985 */
3986void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3987
3988/**
3989 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
3990 *
3991 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
3992 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
3993 * before calling this function.
3994 *
3995 * @hw: the hardware to free
3996 */
3997void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3998
3999/**
4000 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4001 *
4002 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4003 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4004 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4005 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4006 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4007 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4008 *
4009 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4010 */
4011void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4012
4013/**
4014 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4015 *
4016 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4017 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4018 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4019 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4020 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4021 *
4022 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4023 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4024 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4025 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4026 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4027 *
4028 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4029 *
4030 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4031 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4032 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4033 * @napi: the NAPI context
4034 */
4035void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4036		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4037
4038/**
4039 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4040 *
4041 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4042 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4043 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4044 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4045 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4046 *
4047 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4048 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4049 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4050 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4051 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4052 *
4053 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4054 *
4055 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4056 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4057 */
4058static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4059{
4060	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4061}
4062
4063/**
4064 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4065 *
4066 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4067 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4068 *
4069 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4070 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4071 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4072 *
4073 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4074 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4075 */
4076void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4077
4078/**
4079 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4080 *
4081 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4082 * (internally disables bottom halves).
4083 *
4084 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4085 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4086 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4087 *
4088 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4089 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4090 */
4091static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4092				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4093{
4094	local_bh_disable();
4095	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4096	local_bh_enable();
4097}
4098
4099/**
4100 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4101 *
4102 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4103 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4104 * entering/leaving PS mode.
4105 *
4106 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4107 *
4108 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4109 * each other.
4110 *
 
 
4111 * @sta: currently connected sta
4112 * @start: start or stop PS
4113 *
4114 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4115 */
4116int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4117
4118/**
4119 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4120 *                                  (in process context)
4121 *
4122 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4123 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4124 * applies.
4125 *
4126 * @sta: currently connected sta
4127 * @start: start or stop PS
4128 *
4129 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4130 */
4131static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4132						  bool start)
4133{
4134	int ret;
4135
4136	local_bh_disable();
4137	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4138	local_bh_enable();
4139
4140	return ret;
4141}
4142
4143/**
4144 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4145 * @sta: currently connected station
4146 *
4147 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4148 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4149 * connected station was received.
4150 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4151 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4152 * be serialized.
4153 */
4154void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4155
4156/**
4157 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4158 * @sta: currently connected station
4159 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4160 *
4161 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4162 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4163 * from a connected station was received.
4164 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4165 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4166 * serialized.
4167 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
4168 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
4169 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
4170 * checks.
4171 */
4172void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
4173
4174/*
4175 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
4176 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
4177 */
4178#define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
4179
4180/**
4181 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
4182 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
4183 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
4184 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
4185 *
4186 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
4187 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
4188 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
4189 *
4190 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
4191 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
4192 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
4193 * call! Beware of the locking!)
4194 *
4195 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
4196 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
4197 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
4198 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
4199 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
4200 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
4201 *
4202 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
4203 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
4204 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
4205 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
4206 * use this API.
4207 */
4208void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4209				u8 tid, bool buffered);
4210
4211/**
4212 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
4213 *
4214 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
4215 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
4216 * rate selection table for the station entry.
4217 *
4218 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4219 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
4220 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
4221 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
4222 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
4223 */
4224void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4225			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4226			    struct sk_buff *skb,
4227			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
4228			    int max_rates);
4229
4230/**
4231 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
4232 *
4233 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
4234 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
4235 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
4236 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
4237 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
4238 * slow stations to starve).
4239 *
4240 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
4241 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
4242 */
4243void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4244					   u32 thr);
4245
4246/**
4247 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
4248 *
4249 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
4250 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
4251 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
4252 *
4253 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4254 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
4255 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
4256 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4257 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
4258 *
4259 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4260 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4261 */
4262void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4263			 struct sk_buff *skb);
4264
4265/**
4266 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
4267 *
4268 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4269 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
4270 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
4271 *
4272 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4273 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4274 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4275 *
4276 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4277 * @status: tx status information
4278 */
4279void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4280			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
4281
4282/**
4283 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
4284 *
4285 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4286 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
4287 * specific skbs.
4288 *
4289 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4290 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4291 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4292 *
4293 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4294 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
4295 *	(NULL for multicast packets)
4296 * @info: tx status information
4297 */
4298static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4299					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4300					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
4301{
4302	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
4303		.sta = sta,
4304		.info = info,
4305	};
4306
4307	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
4308}
4309
4310/**
4311 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
4312 *
4313 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
4314 *
4315 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4316 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
4317 * for a single hardware.
4318 *
4319 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4320 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4321 */
4322static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4323					  struct sk_buff *skb)
4324{
4325	local_bh_disable();
4326	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
4327	local_bh_enable();
4328}
4329
4330/**
4331 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
4332 *
4333 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
4334 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4335 *
4336 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4337 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4338 *
4339 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4340 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4341 */
4342void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4343				 struct sk_buff *skb);
4344
4345/**
4346 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
4347 *
4348 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
4349 * connected STA.
4350 *
4351 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
4352 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
4353 */
4354void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
4355
4356#define IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM 2
4357
4358/**
4359 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
4360 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
4361 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
4362 * @csa_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
4363 *	to CSA counters.  This array can contain zero values which
4364 *	should be ignored.
4365 */
4366struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
4367	u16 tim_offset;
4368	u16 tim_length;
4369
4370	u16 csa_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM];
4371};
4372
4373/**
4374 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
4375 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4376 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4377 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
4378 *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
4379 *
4380 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4381 * obtain the beacon template.
4382 *
4383 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
4384 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
4385 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
4386 * applicable, the CSA count.
4387 *
4388 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4389 *
4390 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4391 */
4392struct sk_buff *
4393ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4394			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4395			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs);
4396
4397/**
4398 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
4399 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4400 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4401 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
4402 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4403 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
4404 *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
4405 *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4406 *
4407 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4408 * obtain the beacon frame.
4409 *
4410 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4411 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
4412 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
4413 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
 
 
 
 
4414 *
4415 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4416 *
4417 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4418 */
4419struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4420					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4421					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length);
4422
4423/**
4424 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
4425 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4426 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4427 *
4428 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4429 *
4430 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4431 */
4432static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4433						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
4434{
4435	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL);
4436}
4437
4438/**
4439 * ieee80211_csa_update_counter - request mac80211 to decrement the csa counter
4440 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4441 *
4442 * The csa counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
4443 * This function is called implicitly when
4444 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
4445 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
4446 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's csa counters.
4447 *
4448 * Return: new csa counter value
4449 */
4450u8 ieee80211_csa_update_counter(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4451
4452/**
4453 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
4454 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4455 *
4456 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
4457 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
4458 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
4459 */
4460void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4461
4462/**
4463 * ieee80211_csa_is_complete - find out if counters reached 1
4464 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4465 *
4466 * This function returns whether the channel switch counters reached zero.
4467 */
4468bool ieee80211_csa_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4469
4470
4471/**
4472 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
4473 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4474 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4475 *
4476 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
4477 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
4478 *
4479 * Can only be called in AP mode.
4480 *
4481 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
4482 */
4483struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4484					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4485
4486/**
4487 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
4488 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4489 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4490 *
4491 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
4492 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
4493 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
4494 *
4495 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
4496 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
4497 *
4498 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
4499 */
4500struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4501				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4502
4503/**
4504 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
4505 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4506 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4507 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
4508 *	if at all possible
4509 *
4510 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
4511 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
4512 * BSSID and address is used.
4513 *
4514 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
4515 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
4516 *
4517 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
4518 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
4519 *
4520 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
4521 */
4522struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4523				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4524				       bool qos_ok);
4525
4526/**
4527 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
4528 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4529 * @src_addr: source MAC address
4530 * @ssid: SSID buffer
4531 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
4532 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
 
4533 *
4534 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
4535 * hardware.
4536 *
4537 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
4538 */
4539struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4540				       const u8 *src_addr,
4541				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
4542				       size_t tailroom);
4543
4544/**
4545 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
4546 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4547 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4548 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
4549 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
4550 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4551 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
4552 *
4553 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4554 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4555 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
4556 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
4557 */
4558void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4559		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
4560		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
4561		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
4562
4563/**
4564 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
4565 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4566 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4567 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
4568 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4569 *
4570 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
4571 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4572 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
4573 *
4574 * Return: The duration.
4575 */
4576__le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4577			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
4578			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
4579
4580/**
4581 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
4582 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4583 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4584 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
4585 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
4586 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4587 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
4588 *
4589 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4590 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4591 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
4592 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
4593 */
4594void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
4597			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
4598			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
4599
4600/**
4601 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
4602 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4603 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4604 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
4605 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4606 *
4607 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
4608 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4609 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
4610 *
4611 * Return: The duration.
4612 */
4613__le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4614				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4615				    size_t frame_len,
4616				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
4617
4618/**
4619 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
4620 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4621 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4622 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
4623 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
4624 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
4625 *
4626 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
4627 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
4628 *
4629 * Return: The duration.
4630 */
4631__le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4632					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4633					enum nl80211_band band,
4634					size_t frame_len,
4635					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
4636
4637/**
4638 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
4639 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4640 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4641 *
4642 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
4643 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
4644 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
4645 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
4646 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
4647 *
4648 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
4649 * frames are available.
4650 *
4651 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
4652 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
4653 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
4654 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
4655 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
4656 * use common code for all beacons.
4657 */
4658struct sk_buff *
4659ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4660
4661/**
4662 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
4663 *
4664 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
4665 *
4666 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4667 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
4668 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
4669 */
4670void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4671			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
4672
4673/**
4674 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
4675 *
4676 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
4677 * from the given packet.
4678 *
4679 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4680 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
4681 *	with this P1K
4682 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
4683 */
4684static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4685					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
4686{
4687	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
4688	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
4689	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
4690
4691	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
4692}
4693
4694/**
4695 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
4696 *
4697 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
4698 * and transmitter address.
4699 *
4700 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4701 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
4702 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
4703 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
4704 */
4705void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4706			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
4707
4708/**
4709 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
4710 *
4711 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
4712 * in the packet.
4713 *
4714 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4715 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
4716 *	encrypted with this key
4717 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
4718 */
4719void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4720			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
4721
4722/**
4723 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
4724 *
4725 * @pos: start of crypto header
4726 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4727 * @pn: PN to add
4728 *
4729 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
4730 * the packet payload)
4731 *
4732 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
4733 * point to the crypto header)
 
 
 
 
 
4734 */
4735u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
 
4736
4737/**
4738 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
4739 *
4740 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4741 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
4742 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
4743 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
4744 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
4745 *
4746 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
4747 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
4748 * by the device and not by mac80211.
4749 *
4750 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
4751 * can be done concurrently.
4752 */
4753void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4754			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4755
4756/**
4757 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
4758 *
4759 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4760 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
4761 *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
4762 *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
4763 * @seq: new sequence data
4764 *
4765 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
4766 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
4767 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
4768 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
4769 *
4770 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
4771 * can be done concurrently.
4772 */
4773void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4774			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4775
4776/**
4777 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
4778 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4779 *
4780 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
4781 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
4782 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
4783 *
4784 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
4785 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
4786 */
4787void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
4788
4789/**
4790 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
4791 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
4792 * @keyconf: new key data
4793 *
4794 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
4795 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
4796 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
4797 *
4798 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
4799 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
4800 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
4801 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
4802 *
4803 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
4804 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
4805 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
4806 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
4807 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
4808 * of the reconfiguration.
4809 *
4810 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
4811 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
4812 *
4813 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
4814 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
4815 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
4816 * the key that's being replaced.
4817 */
4818struct ieee80211_key_conf *
4819ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4820			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
4821
4822/**
4823 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
4824 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
4825 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
4826 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
4827 * @gfp: allocation flags
4828 */
4829void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
4830				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
4831
4832/**
4833 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
4834 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4835 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
4836 *
4837 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
4838 */
4839void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
4840
4841/**
4842 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
4843 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4844 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
4845 *
4846 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
4847 */
4848void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
4849
4850/**
4851 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
4852 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4853 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
4854 *
4855 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
4856 *
4857 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
4858 */
4859
4860int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
4861
4862/**
4863 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
4864 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4865 *
4866 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
4867 */
4868void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4869
4870/**
4871 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
4872 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4873 *
4874 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
4875 */
4876void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4877
4878/**
4879 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
4880 *
4881 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
4882 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
4883 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
4884 * any context, including hardirq context.
4885 *
4886 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
4887 * @info: information about the completed scan
4888 */
4889void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4890			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
4891
4892/**
4893 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
4894 *
4895 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
4896 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
4897 *
4898 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
4899 */
4900void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4901
4902/**
4903 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
4904 *
4905 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
4906 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
4907 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
4908 * while associating, for instance.
4909 *
4910 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
4911 */
4912void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4913
4914/**
4915 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
4916 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
4917 *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
4918 *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
4919 *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
4920 *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
4921 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
4922 *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
4923 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
4924 */
4925enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
4926	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
4927	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
4928	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
4929};
4930
4931/**
4932 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
4933 *
4934 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
4935 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
4936 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
4937 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
4938 *
4939 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
4940 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
4941 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
4942 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
4943 */
4944void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
4945				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
4946						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
4947				  void *data);
4948
4949/**
4950 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
4951 *
4952 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
4953 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
4954 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
4955 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
4956 * be used.
4957 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
4958 *
4959 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
4960 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
4961 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
4962 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
4963 */
4964static inline void
4965ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
4966				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
4967						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
4968				    void *data)
4969{
4970	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
4971				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
4972				     iterator, data);
4973}
4974
4975/**
4976 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
4977 *
4978 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
4979 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
4980 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
4981 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
4982 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
4983 *
4984 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
4985 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
4986 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
4987 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
4988 */
4989void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4990						u32 iter_flags,
4991						void (*iterator)(void *data,
4992						    u8 *mac,
4993						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
4994						void *data);
4995
4996/**
4997 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl - iterate active interfaces
4998 *
4999 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5000 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5001 * This version can only be used while holding the RTNL.
5002 *
5003 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5004 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5005 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5006 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5007 */
5008void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5009					      u32 iter_flags,
5010					      void (*iterator)(void *data,
5011						u8 *mac,
5012						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5013					      void *data);
5014
5015/**
5016 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5017 *
5018 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5019 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5020 * function for them.
5021 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5022 *
5023 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5024 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5025 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5026 */
5027void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5028				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
5029						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5030				       void *data);
5031/**
5032 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5033 *
5034 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5035 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5036 *
5037 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5038 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5039 */
5040void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5041
5042/**
5043 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5044 *
5045 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5046 * workqueue.
5047 *
5048 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5049 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5050 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5051 */
5052void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5053				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
5054				  unsigned long delay);
5055
5056/**
5057 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5058 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5059 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5060 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5061 *
5062 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5063 *
5064 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5065 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5066 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5067 */
5068int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5069				  u16 timeout);
5070
5071/**
5072 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5073 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5074 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5075 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5076 *
5077 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5078 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
5079 * from any context.
5080 */
5081void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5082				      u16 tid);
5083
5084/**
5085 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
5086 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
5087 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
5088 *
5089 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
5090 *
5091 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5092 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5093 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5094 */
5095int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
5096
5097/**
5098 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
5099 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5100 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5101 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
5102 *
5103 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5104 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
5105 * can be called from any context.
5106 */
5107void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5108				     u16 tid);
5109
5110/**
5111 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
5112 *
5113 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
5114 * @addr: station's address
5115 *
5116 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5117 *
5118 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5119 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5120 */
5121struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5122					 const u8 *addr);
5123
5124/**
5125 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
5126 *
5127 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5128 * @addr: remote station's address
5129 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
5130 *
5131 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5132 *
5133 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5134 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5135 *
5136 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
5137 *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
5138 *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
5139 *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
5140 *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
5141 *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
5142 *      is not reliable.
5143 *
5144 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
5145 */
5146struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5147					       const u8 *addr,
5148					       const u8 *localaddr);
5149
5150/**
5151 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
5152 * @hw: the hardware
5153 * @pubsta: the station
5154 * @block: whether to block or unblock
5155 *
5156 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
5157 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
5158 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
5159 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
5160 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
5161 *
5162 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
5163 * manner.
5164 *
5165 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
5166 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
5167 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
5168 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
5169 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
5170 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
5171 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
5172 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
5173 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
5174 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
5175 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
5176 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
5177 * woke up while blocked or not.
5178 */
5179void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5180			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
5181
5182/**
5183 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
5184 * @pubsta: the station
5185 *
5186 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
5187 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
5188 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
5189 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
5190 *
5191 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
5192 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
5193 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
5194 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
5195 *
5196 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
5197 *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
5198 *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
5199 *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
5200 */
5201void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
5202
5203/**
5204 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
5205 * @pubsta: the station
5206 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
5207 *
5208 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
5209 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
5210 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
5211 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
5212 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
5213 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
5214 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
5215 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
5216 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
5217 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
5218 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
5219 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
5220 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
5221 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
5222 */
5223void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
5224
5225/**
5226 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
5227 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5228 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5229 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5230 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5231 *
5232 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5233 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5234 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
5235 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
5236 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
5237 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
5238 *
5239 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
5240 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
5241 * set_key callback.
5242 */
5243void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5244			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5245			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5246				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5247				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5248				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5249				      void *data),
5250			 void *iter_data);
5251
5252/**
5253 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
5254 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5255 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5256 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5257 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5258 *
5259 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5260 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5261 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
5262 * in removal process will be skipped.
5263 *
5264 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
5265 * and thus iter must be atomic.
5266 */
5267void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5268			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5269			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5270					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5271					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5272					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5273					  void *data),
5274			     void *iter_data);
5275
5276/**
5277 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
5278 * @hw: pointre obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5279 * @iter: iterator function
5280 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
5281 *
5282 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
5283 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
5284 * places while calling into the driver.
5285 *
5286 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
5287 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
5288 * removed.
5289 *
5290 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
5291 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
5292 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
5293 * or not.
5294 */
5295void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
5296	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5297	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5298		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
5299		     void *data),
5300	void *iter_data);
5301
5302/**
5303 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5304 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5305 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5306 *
5307 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5308 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
5309 * information. This function must only be called from within the
5310 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
5311 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
5312 * %NULL.
5313 *
5314 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5315 */
5316struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5317					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5318
5319/**
5320 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
5321 *
5322 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5323 *
5324 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
5325 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
5326 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
5327 */
5328void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5329
5330/**
5331 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
5332 *
5333 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5334 *
5335 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
5336 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
5337 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
5338 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
5339 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
5340 *
5341 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
5342 * without connection recovery attempts.
5343 */
5344void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5345
5346/**
5347 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
5348 *
5349 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5350 *
5351 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
5352 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
5353 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
5354 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
5355 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
5356 *
5357 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
5358 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
5359 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
5360 * disconnect normally later.
5361 *
5362 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
5363 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
5364 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
5365 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
5366 */
5367void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5368
5369/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5370 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
5371 *	rssi threshold triggered
5372 *
5373 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5374 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
5375 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
5376 * @gfp: context flags
5377 *
5378 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
5379 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
5380 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
5381 */
5382void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5383			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
5384			       s32 rssi_level,
5385			       gfp_t gfp);
5386
5387/**
5388 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
5389 *
5390 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5391 * @gfp: context flags
5392 */
5393void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
5394
5395/**
5396 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
5397 *
5398 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
 
5399 */
5400void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5401
5402/**
5403 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
5404 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5405 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
5406 *
5407 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
5408 * and wake up the suspended queues.
5409 */
5410void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
5411
5412/**
5413 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
5414 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5415 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
5416 *
5417 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
5418 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
5419 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
5420 */
5421void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5422			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
5423
5424/**
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
5425 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
5426 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5427 */
5428void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5429
5430/**
5431 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
5432 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5433 */
5434void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5435
5436/**
5437 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
5438 *
5439 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
5440 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
5441 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
5442 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
5443 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
5444 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
5445 *
5446 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5447 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
5448 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
5449 */
5450void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
5451				  const u8 *addr);
5452
5453/**
5454 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
5455 * @pubsta: station struct
5456 * @tid: the session's TID
5457 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
5458 *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
5459 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
5460 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
5461 *
5462 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
5463 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
5464 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
5465 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
5466 */
5467void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
5468					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
5469					  u16 received_mpdus);
5470
5471/**
5472 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
5473 *
5474 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
5475 * buffer.
5476 *
5477 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5478 * @ra: the peer's destination address
5479 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
5480 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
5481 */
5482void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
5483
5484/**
5485 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
5486 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5487 * @addr: station mac address
5488 * @tid: the rx tid
5489 */
5490void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
5491				 unsigned int tid);
5492
5493/**
5494 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
5495 *
5496 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
5497 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
5498 * reordering.
5499 *
5500 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
5501 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
5502 *
5503 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5504 * @addr: station mac address
5505 * @tid: the rx tid
5506 */
5507static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5508						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
5509{
5510	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
5511		return;
5512	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
5513}
5514
5515/**
5516 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
5517 *
5518 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
5519 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
5520 * reordering.
5521 *
5522 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
5523 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
5524 *
5525 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5526 * @addr: station mac address
5527 * @tid: the rx tid
5528 */
5529static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5530						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
5531{
5532	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
5533		return;
5534	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
5535}
5536
5537/**
5538 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
5539 *
5540 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
5541 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
5542 *
5543 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
5544 *
5545 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5546 * @addr: station mac address
5547 * @tid: the rx tid
5548 */
5549void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5550				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
5551
5552/* Rate control API */
5553
5554/**
5555 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
5556 *
5557 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
5558 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
5559 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
5560 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
5561 *	to be filled in
5562 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
5563 *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
5564 *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
5565 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
5566 *	RTS threshold
5567 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
5568 *	if the selected rate supports it
5569 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
5570 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
 
 
 
 
5571 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
5572 */
5573struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
5574	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
5575	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
5576	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
5577	struct sk_buff *skb;
5578	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
5579	bool rts, short_preamble;
 
5580	u32 rate_idx_mask;
5581	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
5582	bool bss;
5583};
5584
5585struct rate_control_ops {
 
5586	const char *name;
5587	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct dentry *debugfsdir);
5588	void (*free)(void *priv);
5589
5590	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
5591	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5592			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
5593			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
5594	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5595			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
5596			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
5597			    u32 changed);
5598	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5599			 void *priv_sta);
5600
5601	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
5602			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5603			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
5604	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5605			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
5606			  struct sk_buff *skb);
5607	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
5608			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
5609
5610	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
5611				struct dentry *dir);
5612	void (*remove_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta);
5613
5614	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
5615};
5616
5617static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5618				 enum nl80211_band band,
5619				 int index)
5620{
5621	return (sta == NULL || sta->supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
5622}
5623
5624/**
5625 * rate_control_send_low - helper for drivers for management/no-ack frames
5626 *
5627 * Rate control algorithms that agree to use the lowest rate to
5628 * send management frames and NO_ACK data with the respective hw
5629 * retries should use this in the beginning of their mac80211 get_rate
5630 * callback. If true is returned the rate control can simply return.
5631 * If false is returned we guarantee that sta and sta and priv_sta is
5632 * not null.
5633 *
5634 * Rate control algorithms wishing to do more intelligent selection of
5635 * rate for multicast/broadcast frames may choose to not use this.
5636 *
5637 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination. Note
5638 * 	that this may be null.
5639 * @priv_sta: private rate control structure. This may be null.
5640 * @txrc: rate control information we sholud populate for mac80211.
5641 */
5642bool rate_control_send_low(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5643			   void *priv_sta,
5644			   struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
5645
5646
5647static inline s8
5648rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5649		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
5650{
5651	int i;
5652
5653	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
5654		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
5655			return i;
5656
5657	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
5658	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
5659
5660	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
5661	return 0;
5662}
5663
5664static inline
5665bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5666			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
5667{
5668	unsigned int i;
5669
5670	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
5671		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
5672			return true;
5673	return false;
5674}
5675
5676/**
5677 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
5678 *
5679 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
5680 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
5681 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
5682 * the most recent rate control module decision.
5683 *
5684 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5685 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
5686 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
5687 */
5688int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5689			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5690			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
5691
5692int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
5693void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
5694
5695static inline bool
5696conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5697{
5698	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
5699}
5700
5701static inline bool
5702conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5703{
5704	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
5705	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
5706}
5707
5708static inline bool
5709conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5710{
5711	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
5712	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
5713}
5714
5715static inline bool
5716conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5717{
5718	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
5719}
5720
5721static inline bool
5722conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
5723{
5724	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
5725		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
5726		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
5727}
5728
5729static inline enum nl80211_iftype
5730ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
5731{
5732	if (p2p) {
5733		switch (type) {
5734		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
5735			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
5736		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
5737			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
5738		default:
5739			break;
5740		}
5741	}
5742	return type;
5743}
5744
5745static inline enum nl80211_iftype
5746ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
5747{
5748	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
5749}
5750
5751/**
5752 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
5753 *
5754 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
5755 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
5756 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
5757 *
5758 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
5759 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
5760 * matching GroupId management frame.
5761 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
5762 */
5763void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5764				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
5765
5766void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5767				   int rssi_min_thold,
5768				   int rssi_max_thold);
5769
5770void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5771
5772/**
5773 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
5774 *
5775 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
5776 *
5777 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
5778 *
5779 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
5780 * applicable.
5781 */
5782int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5783
5784/**
5785 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
5786 * @vif: virtual interface
5787 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
5788 * @gfp: allocation flags
5789 *
5790 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
5791 */
5792void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5793				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
5794				    gfp_t gfp);
5795
5796/**
5797 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
5798 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5799 * @vif: virtual interface
5800 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
5801 * @band: the band to transmit on
5802 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
5803 *
5804 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
5805 */
5806bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5807			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
5808			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
5809
5810/**
5811 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
5812 *
5813 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
5814 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
5815 *
5816 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
5817 *
5818 * private:
5819 *
5820 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
5821 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
5822 */
5823struct ieee80211_noa_data {
5824	u32 next_tsf;
5825	bool has_next_tsf;
5826
5827	u8 absent;
5828
5829	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
5830	struct {
5831		u32 start;
5832		u32 duration;
5833		u32 interval;
5834	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
5835};
5836
5837/**
5838 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
5839 *
5840 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
5841 * @data: NoA tracking data
5842 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
5843 *
5844 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
5845 */
5846int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
5847			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
5848
5849/**
5850 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
5851 *
5852 * @data: NoA tracking data
5853 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
5854 */
5855void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
5856
5857/**
5858 * ieee80211_tdls_oper - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
5859 * @vif: virtual interface
5860 * @peer: the peer's destination address
5861 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
5862 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
5863 * @gfp: allocation flags
5864 *
5865 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
5866 */
5867void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
5868				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
5869				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
5870
5871/**
5872 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
5873 *
5874 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
5875 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
5876 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
5877 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
5878 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
5879 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
5880 *
5881 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
5882 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
5883 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
5884 *
5885 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
5886 * @tid: the TID to reserve
5887 *
5888 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
5889 */
5890int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5891
5892/**
5893 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
5894 *
5895 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
5896 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
5897 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
5898 *
5899 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
5900 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
5901 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
5902 *
5903 * @sta: the station
5904 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
5905 */
5906void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5907
5908/**
5909 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
5910 *
5911 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5912 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
5913 *
5914 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
5915 */
5916struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5917				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
5918
5919/**
5920 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
5921 *
5922 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
5923 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
5924 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
5925 *
5926 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
5927 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
5928 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
5929 */
5930void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
5931			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
5932			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
5933
5934/**
5935 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
5936 *
5937 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
5938 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
5939 *
5940 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5941 * @inst_id: the local instance id
5942 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
5943 * @gfp: allocation flags
5944 */
5945void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5946				   u8 inst_id,
5947				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
5948				   gfp_t gfp);
5949
5950/**
5951 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
5952 *
5953 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
5954 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
5955 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
5956 *
5957 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5958 * @match: match event information
5959 * @gfp: allocation flags
5960 */
5961void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5962			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
5963			      gfp_t gfp);
5964
5965#endif /* MAC80211_H */